lS Pibrary of the Museum Or COMPARATIVE ZOOLOGY, AT HARVARD COLLEGE, CAMBRIDGE, MASS, Founded oy private subscription, in 1861. Deposited by ALEX. AGASSIZ. No. Vi SC - ae A Oe ee QUARTERLY JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. EDWIN LANKESTER, M.D., F.R.S., F.L.S., AND GEORGE BUSK, F.R.C.S.E., F.R.S., F.L.S. VOLUME IV. Gith Allustrations on Wood and Stone. LONDON: JOHN CHURCHILL, NEW BURLINGTON STREET. 1856 QUARTERLY JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. ORIGINAL COMMUNICATIONS. Notice of some New Species of British Fresn-WaTER Diatomacez. By Witiiam Grecory, M.D., F. RS.E, Professor of Chemistry. Havine examined with some minuteness the fossil Diatoms in the Mull earth and in the Glenshira sand, both of which deposits yielded a very large number of species, I felt desirous to compare with them the species at present living in our waters. Accordingly I obtained, from various friends, gather- ings from a great many different localities, both in England and in Scotland. Those which I have been able to study with some care, up to the present time, are almost all from fresh water, and, postponing to a future opportunity an account of the marine gatherings, I propose now very briefly to notice the results obtained from a number of fresh-water gatherings, more especially with reference to such species as are either altogether new or new to Britain. It is well known that in no department of Natural History are the species, whether recent or fossil, so universally distri- buted over the earth’s surface. All the more common species are found, according to Ehrenberg, in his recent great work, ‘ Microgeologie,’ not only in the Arctic and Antarctic regions, but under the Equator, between the tropics, and in the tem- perate zones. But few forms seem to be characteristic of any country or quarter of the globe. The remarkable genus Terp- sine, and a few others, have not yet occurred in Europe, but are found at widely distant localities in other parts of the world. A very striking example of the wide-spread distribu- tion of diatoms is that of a beautiful little Prnnularia, which I first noticed in the Mull earth, and which Mr. Smith, who shortly afterwards found it recent at Grasmere, named Pinna- laria latestriata, a name which [| adopted instead of P. Hebri- densis. \ have since met with it in at least three-fourths of all the gatherings I have examined from fresh waier, although invariably scattered. I could find no figure of this species in VOL. IV. B 2 DR. GREGORY, ON SOME NEW SPECIES any work to which I had access, neither in Ehrenberg’s Atlas of 1838, in Kiitzing, nor in Rabenhorst. Nordid any English observer know it. But I now find that Ehrenberg had de- scribed it as P. borealis ten or twelve years ago, although his figure, which, if published, appeared in the Berlin Transactions or the Berlin Monthly Reports, was entirely unknown to all our authorities in this country, none of whom, more than my- self, have been able to consult Ehrenberg’s very numerous papers on the Berlin Transactions, or Monthly Reports, except as quoted by Kiitzing or Rabenhorst, neither of whom noticed this species. I mention these facts, to explain how it was, that a species long ago described, and I believe figured, by Ehrenberg, was regarded by all our authorities as new when I found it in the Mull earth two years ago. And now I find, in Ehrenberg’s Microgeologie, not only that the species is com- mon, which, so far as concerns Britain, I had myself noticed, but that it is one of two specified by him as occurring in every latitude and in every quarter of the globe, more uniformly than any others.* The fact, that it so long escaped notice in this country is explained by its occurring always scattered, and * The two forms named by Ehrenberg are Pinnularia borealis and Eunotia (Nitaschia, Sm.) amphioxys. Having lately examined about 60 small specimens of earth, found attached to plants in the University Herbarium here, and given to me by Professor Balfour, I find, in accord- ance with what is stated by Ehrenberg, that every one of these specimens of earth, which are chiefly from different parts of South America, contains diatomaceous exuvie, and many of them in considerable quantity. I have detected, in examining only one slide of that part of each earth which is insoluble in acids, not only Diatomacex, to the extent of from 20 to 40 or even 50 species, in each case, most of which are identical with British forms, but also spicules of Sponges, and many Phitolitharia, exactly as Ehrenberg has done in the numerous similar earths analysed by him. It is most remarkable, that the two species above named occur in at least four-fifths of all the exotic earths I have yet examined; and one of them, P. borealis, in very nearly the whole of them. I may add, that I seldom explore a fresh-water gathering at home without finding one or both of these two species. Sufficient attention has not yet been paid to the fact of the invariable presence of Diatomacez, &c., in all earths in which plants are found. Ehrenberg, in his ‘ Microgeologie,’ has established the fact as an universal one, and pointed out the important bearing it has on the growth of the soil. Indeed, it is difficult to imagine a more effectual agent in the transference of silica from the waters to the solid earth, than the growth of Diatomacezx, the shells of which are as indestructible as their multiplication is rapid. Ehrenberg is of opinion that they live in the soil, as well as in water, and the constant presence of moisture in the soil renders this conceivable. Although the proportion of silicious matter, dissolved in ordinary water, is but small, it is evidently sufficient to supply the shells of millions of Diatoms in a very short time; and it is therefore probable, that as fast as it is extracted from the water by them, it is dissolved from the rocks or earths i in contact with the water ; so that the supply never fails. OF BRITISH FRESH-WATER DIATOMACE. 3 never, as many other forms do, in crowds together. But this consideration shows the necessity of minute search, without which many of the scattered forms would escape observation. Many similar examples might be adduced. It would be intolerably tedious to give a list of all the species observed in these gatherings, of which I have examined, more or less minutely, upwards of 200. I may state that, with few exceptions, | have met with all the known British fresh water species, and that I have found various new localities for many rare and curious forms. Few, if any, of the new species which have occurred, are confined to one locality; most of them have been found in several and these widely distant stations. These new species may be conveniently arranged in three sections: 1. Those already described by foreign naturalists, but now first detected as British forms. 2. Those which, although I have myself recognised them as entirely new forms, have been also, either about the same time or subsequently, observed by others. Although these are still unpublished MS. species, and in many cases, my own observations were by much the earliest, yet as I find that these forms have been named by Mr, Smith, I adopt his names, to avoid the confu- sion arising from synonyms. 98. Species which, so far as I can discover, have nowhere as yet been described or figured. I. Species, now first found as British, but known to foreign authors. 1. Eunotia tridentula, Ebr., fig. 1, Pl. 1.*—Banffshire, R. Findhorn. 2. Navicula follis, Ehr.—Lochleven, (qu. ? Trochus ?) 3. IN. dubia, Kiitz.— Elgin, Lochleven. 4. N. bacillum, Ehr.—- Lochleven. 5. Pinnularia nodosa, Kiitz. (Legumen, Ehr.)— Elgin, Elchies, &c. 6. P. megaloptera, Ehr.—Benrinnes, Elgin. 7. P. dactylus, Ehr.—Benrinnes, Elgin. 8. P. pygmaea, Ebr. (Nana, W. G.)—Near Edinburgh. 9. Stauroneis Legumen, Kutz.—Elgin, R. Findhorn, Dud- dingston Loch. 10. S. ventricosa, Kutz.—Elchies, Elgin. 11. Cocconema cornutum, Ehr. ?—Lochleven. 12. Gomphenema subtile, Ehr., Elgin.—Glenshire sand. 13. Meloma distans, Ehr. (Gallionella).—Elgin, Elchies, Lochleven. I do not give these as in all cases absolutely distinct species, * The species are numbered to correspond with the figures in Plate I. B 2 4 DR. GREGORY, ON SOME NEW SPECIES but only as the forms figured under the names here given by Ehrenberg and Kiitzing. It is indeed probable that Pinnularia megaloptera is only a long form of P. costata (lata, Sm.) ; and that NV. dubia may be a variety, as some believe, of N_ firma, although I am rather inclined to think that WN. amphigomphus, Ehr. and JV. dilatata, Ebr., both of which occur in Lochleven with WV. dubia, may be forms of one species with the latter, but distinct from WN. firma. For this reason, I have only mentioned NV. dubia in my list. The remarkable form which I have referred to NV. Bacillum, Ehr. is perhaps, as I find from Ehrenberg’s ‘ Microgeologie,’ rather his MN. Americana, al- though, to judge from his figures, these two form but one species. It is also probable that Pinnularia Dactylus is only a variety of P. major. II. MS. species ; named by Prof. Smith, but unpublished. 13. Navicula apiculata, Sm.—Mull earth, Elgin, Dhu Loch, in Glenshire. 14. LV. rostrata, Sm.—Near Haddington, Lochleven; near Oban, Linlithgowshire, Dhu Loch in Glenshira, Elgin; also recently near Hamilton, and at Borthwick Castle. 15. UW. scutelloides, Sm.—N orfolk, Lochleven. 16. Mastogloia Grevillei (for the locality only), Lochleven.* At one time I regarded Navicula scutelloides as one of the innumerable varieties of Navicula varians, a form to which I have lately directed attention, as showing the extent to which shape and outline may vary on the diatoms, without materially affecting other characters. But my friend Dr. Greville has suggested that the form in question is rather a Cocconeis, and his opinion possesses much weight. Ill. Species now first described and figured. 17. Cymbella?} sinuata, W. G—Dhu Loch in Glenshira, * I give a figure of Mastogloia Grevillei, first observed by Dr. Greville in a gathering from the Pentland Hills. I subsequently found it in my Lochleven gathering, but not having then seen Dr. Greville’s species, I did not at first recognise it. It is scarce on the gathering from Lochleven, but will probably be found in abundance in some part of the lake, or in some of the streams which supply it. t+ Iam by no means sure that this form is correctly referred to the genus Cymbella. I at one time supposed it might be a Lunotia, or a Pinnularia, or possibly a Gomphonema. But the general opinion among those to whom I have shown it is that it comes nearest to Cymbella. It is marked, however, as doubtful, Some have conjectured it to be an abnormal state of some form, not specified. But it occurs in so many localities, always with the same characters, that I cannot but regard it as a normal and distinct species. Dr, Greville has recently met with it in various gatherings from the vicinity of the Bridge of Allan, and I have again found it in several from the neighbourhood of Hamilton. OF BRITISH FRESH-WATER DIATOMACEZ. 5 and Loch Etive, Argyllshire; R. Calder and R. Avon, Lanarkshire ; Lochleven. Fossil in the Mull earth and Glen- shira sand. I have thus named the curious little form represented in fig. 17. It is narrow, slightly arcuate, with rather square, slightly expanding apices. On the generally concave side are three rounded but gentle prominences; the central one consi- derable, the lateral ones, which are near the ends, very slight. Striz: conspicuous, sub-distant, about 20 in ‘001, not reaching, or hardly reaching, the median line, which seems to be, as in the known Cymbelle, a little nearer the ventral surface. There is in most cases a blank space round the central nodule. Length from -0008 to 0012 inch. The characters of this species are very constant. It varies somewhat in size, and a little also in the form of the apices, which are in some less square than in others, I first noticed it in the Mull earth, then in a slide mounted by Professor Smith for Gomphonema gemmatum, the locality of which was not given; then in the Glenshira sand, and subse- quently in the other localities named. It has always been, hitherto, scattered, and does not seem to have been yet found in the spots where it grew. But it appears to be widely diffused, 18. Cymbella turgida, W. G. Elgin.—This pretty spe- cies has only occurred to me, as yet, in one British gathering, from a moss near Elgin, but 1 have seen it in two speci- mens of soil from South America. It is short and broad, the dorsal line almost perfectly circular, while the ventral one is nearly straight. The apices are acute, and somewhat pro- duced. The two halves are very unequal, the dorsal being very broad, the ventral remarkably narrow. Strie very con- spicuous, strong and sharp, about 24 in ‘001. Length -002 to (0025 of an inch. Of the British Cymbelle, C. maculata comes nearest to it, but differs in form, in the shape of the apices, in striatum and in general aspect. In the Elgin gather- ing the only one in which as yet it occurs, the species is very uniform and well marked on its characters. 19. Cymbella obtusa, W. G.—This species occurs in many gatherings ; as Lochleven, those from Banffshire, from Lanarkshire, Argyllshire, &c. Dr. Greviile finds it in one from Braid Hills. It is rather small, with very obtuse apices, and the striz are inconspicuous, much finer than in any of the known species, I think I have seen it named C. Scotica, but Professor Smith’s figure of that species, which accurately represents a very common form, is very narrow and has ex- tremely acute apices. Length ‘001 to -0015. Strize about 6 DR. GREGORY, ON SOME NEW SPECIES 36 in ‘001. I name this and the preceding species with some hesitation, not that they are not well-marked forms, as may be seen from the figures, but because the genus Cymbella, as well as the allied one Cocconema, is not in a satisfactory state, and requires a thorough investigation, in which the forms I here describe must be considered. The same remark applies to the next species. 20. Cymbella Pisciculus, W. G.—This form occurs in a very interesting gathering from Norfolk, and Dr. Greville has recently found it near Bridge of Allan. I have also lately seen it in various gatherings, including that from Lochleven. It is rather large, broad, and has somewhat square apices. Length about ‘0016. Striz about 30 in -100. 21. Cymbella Arcus, W. G.—This pretty form I have very recently found in two gatherings from the neighbourhood of Hamilton. The ventral surface is straight, the dorsal highly arcuate, and slightly undulating, broad in the middle, very narrow towards the extremities, like a strung bow. The apices are rather square, expanding a little, after a slight construc- tion. The strize are best seen about the middle, where the frustule is broadest. Length about 0014. Stria about 30 in 001. 22. Navicula cocconeiformis, W. G.—Occurs in Elgin, Elchies, and some other Banffshire localities, and Lochleyen, and recently in various gatherings from different parts of Scotland. In form it is short, broad, nearly oval, but with a slight angularity in the middle, and flattened apices. Some specimens are almost rhombic. In shape it comes very near to Cocconeis flexella (Thwitesii), and it has much the aspect of that form, except that the median line is quite straight. triz not resolvable. Length from -0006 to 0012. I under- stand that this form has been named WN. nugax by Professor Smith, but I consider my own name, given much earlier, as more characteristic. Besides this, Dr. Greville has lately figured it under the name here adopted. 23. Navicula lacustris, W. G.—This fine species has only as yet occurred in the gathering from Lochleven, in which, though not abundant, it is yet far from scarce. It presents two well-marked varieties, « and 8, which pass into each other by intermediate forms: a, which is rather more abundant than the other, is elliptico-lanceolate, with acute apices. Nodule bright in the centre, but without definite outline. Median line double. Stria fine, but distinct, slightly inclined ; about 28 or 30 in. (001; length from ‘0016 to -0025 inch: 6 agrees in every point with a, except in outline. It is broad, has straight sides, sometimes even a little incurvated, and sud- OF BRITISH FRESH-WATER DIATOMACEZ. 7 denly contracted to narrow produced extremities. These two varieties are seen in figs. 23 and 238, and there exists an intermediate form. The only species with which this could in any way be confounded is WN. firma, var. 8. But the latter is longer and larger, always of a brown colour, and in NV. firma not only are the strie much finer and less con- spicuous, but they are almost exactly parallel. It is not easy in a drawing to give certain peculiarities of aspect, but any one who compares the two species, WV. firma 8 and UN. lacustris, will perceive that the latter has an aspect entirely different from the former. Moreover the side lines, always seen in NN. firma, never occur in WN. lacustris. 24, Navicula bacillaris, W. G.—This pretty little species was first observed in several gatherings from Duddingston Loch, and has since occurred in many others, as Lochleven, Elchies, Elgin, and in large quantity in two from the neigh- bourhood of Dundee. It is linear, narrow, with rounded and slightly pointed apices. It has a very smooth aspect, and the striz are so fine that it is difficult to resolve them. Length from ‘0012 to :002 inch, 25. Navicula lepida «2, W. G.—This form occurs in the Lochleven gathering, where it is not rare, and [ have recently seen it in others, as in those from Hunter’s Bog, and in one of Dr. Balfour’s from Borthwick Castle.* It is small, of a narrow oval, and has at first sight a smooth polished aspect; but on closer inspection the striae are seen to be by no means very fine, but rather difficult to catch from their transparency. They are distinctly but slightly radiate. The central nodule is indefinite, and assumes frequently the aspect of a hazy cross-band, approaching to that of a false stauros. It is a very neat and well-marked little form, and its characters are very constant, varying considerably only in length; the average being about 0015 inches. 258. Navicula pileda? 8, W. G.—This is another small form, which in some points is so near the last, that I regard it for the present as a variety of NV. lepida. It is small, of a very short oval shape, and the striz are both more distinct and more radiate than in WV. lepida, but yet it exhibits at first sight the same apparent absence of striation. The difference is in the structure of the nodule, which in the present case is always very definite, transparent and glassy ; the same peculiar aspect is seen in the terminal nodules; this form hardly ever varies even in length. I have only once seen a specimen a good deal longer and narrower in proportion, and consequently * Dr. Greville has also found it in a recent gathering from Duddingston Loch (April, 1855). 8 DR. GREGORY, ON SOME NEW SPECIES in form close to WV. lepida, but the nodule retained its charac- teristic aspect 26. Navicula incurva, W. G.—This elegant species I have observed in two or three gatherings from the River Findhorn, and very sparingly in that from Lochleven. It is rather narrow, with somewhat angular shoulders, contracted suddenly towards the apices, which are produced and square, and more gently towards the centre. Length about ‘0017 inch. The strize have not yet been resolved. It seems to belong to a group, all of which have irresolvable stria, such as NV. producta and WV. affinis; but its very characteristic and constant form render it quite distinct. 27. Navicula longiceps, W. G.—This little form occurs in the Morayshire and Banffshire gatherings along with the equally minute species Pinnularia linearis, P. subcapitata, P. gracil- lima, and N. bacillaris. Yt is small, linear, narrow, but not very long, contracted near the extremities, and subsequently continuing of uniform width to the broadly rounded apices. Nodule indefinite, striae not yet resolved. Length about 0012 inch. It is more frequent in the Elchies gathering than in any of the others, and is very permanent in its characters. I have named it, from the peculiarly long shape of the con- tracted ends. 28. Pinnularia biceps, W. G.—This well-marked form occurs in the gatherings from Elgin, Elchies, and Lochleven, as well as in some others, and is by no means rare. It is rather large, linear, contracted towards the ends, and expand- ing into large round heads. The striz which have, as in P. divergens, three centres of radiation, do not reach the median line, and towards the central nodule leave a large round blank space, on the sides of which of course the strize are much shortened. There are two varieties: 8, which is less con- stricted and subcapitate; and y, which has three undulations on each side, and is capitate like the type. Length from -002 to ‘003 inch. Strie about 24 in ‘001 inch. This species ap- proaches to P. divergens, which, however, is not capitate, and besides has the central blank space in the form of a broad false stauros, reaching to the margin, so that there are no striz on either side of the centra! nodule. 29. Pinnularia linearis, W. G.—This little form occurs in the gatherings from Elgin, Elchies, and several other Banff- shire localities, also in Lochleven and elsewhere. It is small, linear, narrow, very slightly narrower at the apices, and occa- sionally a little contracted just before them. The striz are fine, very nearly parallel, reaching the median line. Nodule sinall, somewhat elongated; it has a distinct border, formed OF BRITISH FRESH-WATER DIATOMACEZ. 9 apparently by a line parallel to the outer margin, and this border is very broad for so small a form. Length from 001 to 0012. Striz about 40 in :001 inch. 30. Pinnularia subcapitata, W. G.—This is another small and linear species, which is found in the same gatherings as the last, and also P. vaciva. It is linear, narrow, constricted, subcapitate, the ends rounded. The striz are subdistant, con- spicuous, short. Length about 0013”. 31. Pinnularia gracillima, W. G.—This species occurs in the Elgin and Elchies gatherings, in others from Banffshire, and in various other localities, It is, | believe, the same as that which Mr. Smith has named P. vaciva; but I had named it long before, and as Dr. Greville has adopted my name in a recent paper in the Annals, I retain it. It is very narrow and long in proportion, varying a good deal in length, as from -0014 to 0025. It has a constriction towards the apices, which again expand into longish rounded heads. Striz fine but distinct ; | have not counted them. Dr. Greville has found this species in the district of the Tummel and elsewhere. 32. Pinnularia digito-radiata, W.G.—This species occurs in several gatherings from Duddingston Loch, also in Loch- leven and elsewhere, and is not very rare. It is rather small, in form linear elliptic or elliptic-lanceolate, and somewhat narrow. It has a delicate aspect, and the strie are dis- tinct, though rather fine, except at the centre, and much inclined. The central nodule expands a good deal laterally, and from it on each side diverge five or six very strong striz or coste in a digitate fashion, as may be seen perhaps a little too strongly marked in fig. 32. This character comes out well under a high power. Length from ‘0014 to ‘002 inch. Strie about -25 in‘Q01”. This species has some resemblance to the more finely striated varieties of what I have named N. varians. But as N. varians occurs along with the new form they are easily compared, and it is seen that the striation of N. varians is much coarser and far more conspicuous, so that the aspect of the two forms is quite different. 33. Pinvularia Elginensis, W. G.—This species is another of the numerous capitate forms which occur in fresh water. It is rather small, not very narrow, with straight sides, con- tracted towards the extremities, and again expanding into somewhat square truncate heads. The nodule is rather inde- finite, the strize not conspicuous but easily resolvable, fine and very slightly radiate or inclined. It may possibly be a Navi- cula, but it is often very difficult to know to which of these two allied genera, Navicula or Pinnularia, we ought to refer a 10 DR. GREGORY, ON SOME NEW SPECIES species. It seems to be distinguished by the character of its striation from all similar forms yet described. NN. varians sometimes takes nearly the same outline, but is at once known by its conspicuous and highly radiate strize. Length about 70013 inch. Striz about 30 in -001”. 34. Pinnularia globiceps.—This elegant little form occurs not unfrequently in a very beautiful gathering from Norfolk, the same in which I first noticed Cymbella pisciculus. 1 have met with it also, or at least a form much resembling it, in the recent mud from the Dhu Loch in Glenshire. It is well marked by its globular extremities and prettily curved outline, swelling a little at the middle part. The terminal nodules are very prominent, casting a shadow, the central are indefi- nite. The striae are fine but sharp and distinct, not reaching the median line. They have three centres of divergence, and are entirely absent from a broad crucial space, like a large false stauros, the upper and lower parts of which pass into the long blank caused by the striz not reaching the median line. In fact the arrangement of the stria and blank space is like what we see in P. divergens, Sm. Towards the apices the blank space expands again. Length ‘0014 inch. Strie from 36 to 40 in 001”. It is possible that this form may be allied to P. Stauronetformis, or to P. divergens, as it is also possible that the two last named may belong to one species. The name must therefore be considered as provisional for the present. In any case it must be distinguished as a striking and well- marked form, even if only a variety. N.B.—Since writing the above I have observed, in some gatherings from the neighbourhood of Duddingston Loch and Arthur’s Seat, as well as in some from the Bridge of Allan, the latter made by Dr. Greville, and in one from Borthwick, made by Dr. Balfour, a form apparently allied to P. globiceps, which for the present I shall call P. globiceps 6. It has a much less elegant curve, but in most points agrees with the form here described. 39. Stauroneis obliqua, W.G.—This very curious and well- marked species has only occurred, as yet, in the gathering from Lochleven, in which it is, though far from frequent, always to be found, from 3 or 4 to 10 or 12 in a slide. In form it is elliptico-lanceolate, usually rather short and broad, sometimes longer. The stauros is broad and distinct, but less so towards the margin, which, however, it reaches. The striz are fine and slightly curved from the middle towards the extremities ; but the most striking character is the peculiar position of the median line, which does not, as usual, unite the apices centrically, but has one of its ends on one side of OF BRITISH FRESH-WATER DIATOMACEZ. 11 the apex, the other on the opposite side of the opposite apex, thus dividing the valve into two halves, which, although equal, are so placed that the narrowest part of one corresponds to the broadest of the other, as is well shown in the figures. In some cases, as may be seen in the larger figure, the median line is slightly sigmoid, but this is rare. The obliquity just described, which I do not remember to have seen in any other species, is invariably present; at least I have found it in at least 150 specimens which I have examined. ‘The length is from :001 to -0022 inch. Striz, by the measurement of Pro- fessor Kelland, 45 in -001 inch. I may add that Professor Kelland thinks the median line is twisted, as it were on its own axis, to a certain extent. 36. Stauroneis (?) ovalis, W. G.—This very pretty little form first occurred to me in some gatherings made on the River Findhorn by my friend Mr. Crawford, of Overton. In one of these it is quite the predominating form, and in all of them WV. incurva, already described, also occurs. I have recently found it, much more sparingly, in Lochleven, in which I also detected NV. incurva. The form is a pure oval, "001 inch long, and it is crossed by what at first I took for a stauros, which is broad and reaches the margin. But I can- not, with a high power, satisfy myself that this is really a stauros, as it seems to vanish, or is so transparent that it cannot well be traced. The valve appears to be convex, as when the stauros is brought into focus, the other parts are but dimly visible. The striz have not yet been resolved. As the genus of this form is not yet determined, I retain the name Stauroneis with a mark of interrogation, It is more probable that it may prove to be a Cocconeis. At all events, it appears to be a distinct and well-marked species. Length about ‘O01 inch. I have recently observed it in two gather- ings from Lanarkshire. 37. Stauroneis dubia, W. G.—This is a still smaller form, and, as the name indicates, its true position is not quite settled. It occurs in some of the gatherings from Dudding- ston Loch, and in others from the Hunter’s Bog, and is far from scarce. It is small, narrow, of an elliptico-lanceolate form, the apices slightly truncated. There is a stauros, whether true or false is not yet ascertained, but probably true. When examined under a high power, the valve exhibits two parallel marginal lines within the margin on each side, the stauros not reaching farther than the inner one of these lines. The strie have not yet been resolved. Length from 0008 to 0012 inch. 38. Surtrella tenera? W. G.—This pretty form occurs in 12 - DR. GREGORY, ON SOME NEW SPECIES the Elchies gathering, where it is frequent, along with S. biseriata and S. nobilis, so that it can be at once distinguished from them. It has exactly the form of S. nobilis, but is smaller and rather narrower in proportion. It differs from S. biseriata in having one end round, the other acute. From both of these species it differs still more in the fact of having its canaliculi very much narrower and more numerous. Its length is from -003 to °005 inch. Canaliculi fine, about 10 in ‘001 inch. It is possible that it may be the perfectly deve- loped S. linearis, but I have not as yet been able to ascertain this. 39. Gomphonema insigne, W. G., rude, Sm.—This species was first observed in some gatherings from Duddingston Loch, but I found it subsequently to be pretty widely distributed. It is distinguished by its size and the coarseness of its striation. The S.V.is doubly conical, the angle at the broadest part being strongly marked. The F. V, is cuneate. Length from -002 to ‘0024 inch. Strize 18 to 20 in 001". I believe that Mr. Smith has named this form, which I sent him when I first observed it, G. rude, but I am not quite certain of this. If so, there can be no objection to his name. 40. Gomphonema ventricosum, W. G.—This well-marked species occurs in a gathering from the banks of the Spey, near Elchies, different from that which I have spoken of as the Elchies gathering. The middle part is much expanded, and both extremities are obtuse and rounded, the longer limb being a little expanded at the apex. It is short and broad in proportion, and very uniform in its characters, Length about "0014 inch. Striaz about 30 or 32 in ‘001". Dr. Greville has recently (April, 1855) found this species tolerably frequent in several gatherings made by him near the Bridge of Allan. 41. Gomphonema equale, W. G.—This species occurs in the Elchies gathering, which is from a spring in the grounds of the house. I have seen it also in that from Elgin, and in some of the other Banffshire gatherings, as well as in some from Lanarkshire. It is shorter than the last, and is distin- guished from it, as well as from other Gomphonemata, by the position of the nodule, which is central, whereas in other species it lies always nearer one end. In form it is linear elliptical, but towards the extremities it is suddenly con- tracted, and again expands, so as to be almost capitate. In this it agrees nearly with some forms of G. tenellum, from which, however, it differs, both in having much wider and coarser stria, and in the central position of the nodule. Length -001 inch. Strie rather distant, not reaching the median line, conspicuous, about 22 or 24 in :001". OF BRITISH FRESH-WATER DIATOMACEZ. 13 42. Gomphonema Sarcophagus, W.G.—This species occurs abundantly in the Lochleven gatherings, but it occurs also in several gatherings made near Edinburgh, and in others from Fife, Stirlingshire, Lanarkshire, and elsewhere. Indeed it would seem not to be uncommon. In form it is linear, rather narrow, the sides gently curved, so as to form a sort of shoulder at the widest part, after which it contracts a little, and again expands to a somewhat truncate extremity. The opposite end is narrower, and, with the exception of a trifling expansion at the apex, becomes continuously narrower. These things give to it very nearly the shape of a coffin. The F. V. is, as usual in this genus, cuneate. Length about -0014 inch. Striz 20 to 22 in -001". I have now only to add a few words on the distribution of the Diatomacee in our fresh waters. I have not only found, as Ehrenberg has done, that a large number of species occur in every locality, but even in the case of the forms just described, which, from their having been overlooked, might be supposed to be very rare, most of them have been observed in more than one, frequently in several different and distant stations. It must not be supposed that the gatherings which I have examined are exhausted. The fact is, that only a small number of them, no doubt the most interesting and the most promising, have been at all minutely explored, and I would particularly direct attention to the fact, that with the exception of only two or three species, all the forms now figured are actually to be found in four gatherings, those, namely, of which I have spoken as Elchies, Elgin, Lochleven, and Dud- dingston Loch. Several of these forms were first observed in other gatherings, though not many, but in time they have all been found in these four. Nay, the Lochleven gathering alone has been found to yield nearly the whole of them. If, therefore, | had been confined to these four gatherings alone, I should have detected, by careful exploration, all the forms now figured as new. This shows what I formerly alluded to, the importance of minute examination, without which many iuteresting forms are daily overlooked. It is no argument against this to say that species cannot well be ascertained from a few scattered specimens, for what is rare and scattered to-day, may be found in abundance to-morrow. ‘Thus the doubtful Stauroneis which | have figured occurs very sparingly in the Lochleven gathering. Had it never occurred but there, its character could have been easily ascertained. But in the Findhorn gatherings it occurs abundantly. Stauronezs obliqua occurs, at present, only in Lochleven, and that sparingly ; but 14 BUSK, ON THE STRUCTURE AND its characters are so well marked that we need not wait till it shall be found in abundance, as it probably will some day. It would, however, certainly have been overlooked in Loch- leven, but for the minute search to which the gathering was subjected. The same remarks apply to Navicula lacustris and to Navicula lepida. Whenever, therefore, a gathering is met with which appears to contain a great variety of forms, like the four above men- tioned, it should be systematically and minutely searched, and any striking forms, no matter how scarce, noted and figured. If true species, they will most probably be found in greater abundance elsewhere. It is much to be regretted that no work yet published con- tains figures of all the known species or forms named as species by their observers. Even in Ehrenberg’s last great work, in which many hundred species are figured, I observe the names of about 350 species, most of which are described as remarkable or characteristic of certain localities, not one of which is figured, although most of the common species are many times represented. Supposing, then, that all those forms which I have just described as new to science should prove to be good and distinct species, of which I cannot, of course, be sure, it is out of my power to ascertain whether they may not agree with some of the species named, but not figured, in his last work, by Ehrenberg. I ought to mention, however, that several of the species of my first section, new to Britain only, were con- sidered by myself and others as new to science, till I found them figured in Ehrenberg’s ‘ Microgeologie,’ when of course I adopted his names for them. An Account of the SrructurE and ReEwations of SaciTta BipuncTaTA. By G. Busk, F.R.S. THE minute creature to which the above name has been given, though abundant, perhaps, in all seas, and noticed so long ago as in the year 1781, has received but little attention from zoologists in general. Its curious and interesting struc- ture, however, and doubtful position in the animal kingdom, render it a subject well worthy of further research; and its minute size, and the extreme delicacy and transparence of its tissues, make it peculiarly an object of microscopical inves- tigation. Though perhaps unknown, even by sight, to many of our readers, the Sagitta bipunctata will probably be met with on every part of the coast; and it may be procured, RELATIONS OF SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA. 15 without difficulty, at any rate in fine and calm weather, by means of a small muslin towing net over the side of a boat. The animal, which has the form of a pointed needle, is from one to two inches in length or less, and transparent as the clearest glass. In warm, calm weather it swims on the surface of the sea, and occasionally in the most surprising numbers, In these latitudes it appears to be in a state of the most complete maturity in August and September. The present account pretends to little originality, except in the figures, some of which were made by myself in 1852, from specimens taken in Sandown Bay in the Isle of Wight; and; for others, [ am indebted tof{Mr. Huxley, whose observ- ations upon this creature were made in the course of the voyage of the ‘ Rattlesnake’ in the seas of Australia. That accurate observer, who has also studied the British form, is of opinion that the Sagitta he examined in the southern hemi- sphere and elsewhere, is identical with that found on our coasts; and I have, therefore, no hesitation in availing my- self of his figures, illustrating the nervous system. The earliest notice of the animal which forms the subject of this paper was given by Martin Slabber* in 1781, by whom also the very appropriate name of Sagitta was applied to it. This notice, however, seems to have been forgotten until M.M. Quoy and Gaimard, when commencing their second voyage round the world, re-discovered the animal, as it may be said, in the Straits of Gibraltar. The species observed by them was named Sagitta bipunctata, and is probably identical with that now under consideration. This form and other species of the same genus have been since noticed and more or less accurately described and figured by several authors, amongst whom may be noticed Scoresby,t D’Orbigny,t Forbes,§ Darwin, || Krohn,{] Wilms,** Huxleyt{ and Busch.tt * ¢Physikalische Belustigungen, oder mikroskopische Wahrnehmungen von 48 in-und auslandischen Wasser-und Landthierchen.’ Nurnberg, 1781. + ‘ Account of the Arctic Regions,’ vol. ii., Plate XVI. { ‘ Voyage dans l’Amerique meridionale ; Mollusques, p. 140, Pilate X., figs. 1—7. “§ ‘Annals Nat. Hist.,” 1843. || ‘ Annals Nat. Hist.,’ lst Ser., vol. xiii., p. 1. “I ‘ Anatomisch-physiologische Beobachtungen wb. die Sagitta bipunc- tata,’ 1844. ‘Nachtragliche Bemerkungen ub. den Bau der Gattung Sagitta, nebst der Beschreibung einiger neuen Arten.’ (Wiegmann’s ‘ Archiv.,’ 1853, p. 266, Plate KL) And Miiller’s ‘ Archiv.,’ 1853, p. 140. ae ik Observationes de Sagitta, mare Germanicum circa insulam Helgo- land incolente,’ 1846. +t Report of British Association, 1851. (Trans. of Sections, p. 77.) {ti Beobachtungen ub. d. Anatom, u. Entwicklung einiger wirbellos. Seethiere, 1851, p. 93. P! XV. Lis I-10 16 BUSK, ON THE STRUCTURE AND The present account of the animal, however, has been com- piled chiefly from the observations of Krohn and Wilms, whose papers on the subject appear to include nearly all of importance that has as yet been made out respecting the anatomy and physiology of Sagitta. The body of the Sagitta lipunctata is as transparent and clear as glass, cylindrical or slightly flattened, pretty regu- larly fusiform, though rather more attenuated posteriorly than in front (PI. IT. fig. 1), when it again expands at the extremity. It is divided into three distinct portions, the ‘‘ head,’ “ trunk,” and ‘“ caudal portion,” which are separated from each other by transverse septa. Each of these portions will be sepa- rately described. Posteriorly the body is furnished, on the sides and extremity, with five delicate membranous expansions, which have received the name of “ fins,” though bearing no real analogy with the fins of a fish. ‘These “ fins” are all in the same plane, and spring from a line equidistant between the dorsal and ventral surfaces. ‘The anterior pair of lateral fins, which are far smaller than the posterior, are situated nearly in the middle of the body, being equal in length to about 1-5th of the extreme length of the animal. The posterior pair of lateral fins, which are both longer and wider, extend from the posterior border of the former to within a short distance of the caudal extremity, where they terminate rather abruptly. Anteriorly the two pairs of fins are often apparently continuous with each other by a very narrow band of similar texture; so that, in fact, im many cases the lateral fins might be described as constituting only one pair, of varying width in different parts. The caudal fin is, however, quite distinct. It is broad and somewhat rounded, expanding like a fan from the posterior extremity of the body, and passing a short distance up on each side. These “ fins” are composed of an excessively delicate and apparently structureless mem- brane, which is strengthened by very slender radiating fibres, placed very closely together, and appearing to be somewhat thicker at the base than more outwardly. Although very slight injury tears the fin in the direction of these apparent fibres—and its edge, thence, often appears to be fimbriated— the fibres themselves cannot be readily isolated, and there is every reason to believe that the edge of the fin in the perfect state is entire. The integument, except on the head, is comparatively speaking thick and dense. It is covered with a very delicate epidermis, composed of rounded or polygonal cells. The existence of this epidermis was denied by Krohn in his first RELATIONS OF SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA. Fé meinoir, but is admitted by him in his subsequent observa- tions. When the animal is placed in spirits of wine, the surface presents numerous distinct, whitish, well-defined spots, which closer examination shows to be rounded eminences belonging to the cellular epidermis, and from which project minute bundles of excessively delicate, rigid filaments or sete. These spicules, as they may be termed, were first pointed out by Wilms,* and the species on that account was termed by J. Miiller, S. setosa; but from Wilms’ description it appears to differ in no important particular from S. bipunc- tata. Wilms describes them as constituting a single series on each side, whilst Busch,f in speaking of a form termed by him S. cephaloptera, notices that they are disposed, in that species, in a double series on each side. Krohn also remarks that he has seen these spicular bundles, not only in S. bipune- tata, but in several other species also; their existence, there- fore, would seem to be general throughout the genus, and careful observation may, perhaps, educe from their disposition specific characters of some importance. In S. bipunctata, the spicules project on all parts of the body, but they appear to be more numerous on the anterior portion than elsewhere. So far as I have observed, they seem to be scattered irregularly over the surface, although Krohn states that they are appa- rently arranged in symmetrical longitudinal tracts on the two sides. He says also, that they occur on the caudal fin where they are disposed in a curved line across its width. In some species he remarks that they exist also on the posterior lateral fins. As has been said before, all these bundles of spicules are placed upon rounded eminences, and in most cases they appear to radiate on all sides from the centre of the eminence ; but closer examination will sometimes show that they are disposed in a simple line, and in close contiguity. This is the case, at any rate, according to Krohn, in S. bipunctata. Notwithstanding their rigidity, the filaments, of which these spicular bundles are constituted, have nothing in common either with spines (aculei) with which Wilms com- pares them, nor with set@, as they are termed by Busch. According to Krohn they are epidermic processes. And this notion he remarks is supported by the circumstance that the spicules, like the epidermis itself, are detached with extreme readiness, and consequently are only to be observed in per- fectly fresh specimens in a good state of preservation. Some analogy may, perhaps, be conceived to exist between the filaments of which these epidermic spicules are consti- Srvc poll, fe. 116, Tr La Gs,py Goa VOL, IV. Cc 18 BUSK, ON THE STRUCTURE AND tuted and those by which the “ fins” are strengthened. With reference to the latter, Krohn remarks that after repeated observation he is convinced that these fibres are closely allied to the sete of Annelids, Like these they are flexible to a certain extent, and are readily broken into pieces. In form they exactly resemble the simple or capillary sete. He remarks also, though this hardly accords with my own ob- servation, that they are merely loosely imbedded in the homogeneous substance of the fin; since they may often, in otherwise uninjured “ fins,” be seen bare for a considerable extent. At any rate their connection with the substance of the fins is by no means so close as he was formerly inclined to believe.* Immediately beneath the integument is placed a layer of longitudinal muscles extending uninterruptedly from the head to the caudal portion of the “body. These muscles are dis- posed in two broad bands, one situated on the dorsal and the other on the abdominal aspect, and separated on each side by a clear space, which is brought more distinctly into view, as Krohn remarks, when the muscles themselves are rendered opaque by immersion in spirit. Each band is again sub- divided, but less distinctly, into a right and left portion; so that in fact the muscular apparatus might be described as consisting of four bands, a dorsal and an abdominal on either side. These muscular bands are composed of long trans- versely striated fasciculi resembling those of insects. The disposition of the muscular apparatus would indicate, as observation shows to be the case, that the movements of the animal are chiefly those of flexion and extension in the trans- verse plane of the body, and consequently that the Sagitta, as was observed by Quoy and Gaimard, swims like a Cetacean by the horizontal blows of its caudal fin upon the water. The Nervous system, in Sagitta bipunctata, may be described as consisting of two principal ganglions, one situated on the dorsal aspect of the head, the cephalic ganglion, and the other on the ventral aspect of the trunk, the ventral ganglion. The one consequently is above the cesophagus, and the other below it, —supra and sub-cesophageal ganglia. These ganglia—which, as well as the nervous trunks, lie immediately beneath, and in close contact with the integument—are mainly composed, as in other instances, of ganglionic cells, but in the ventral ganglion there appears to be a certain amount of white nervous matter in the centre (fig. 8, h). The cephalic, or supra-csophageal ganglion (fig. 7), situated in the mesian line, a short distance from the anterior ¥uioc., p. 6. RELATIONS OF SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA. 2) extremity of the head. It is of a more or less quadrangular form and flattened, in large specimens measuring about } mm. in length. Three pairs of nervous cords proceed from it. 1. An anterior (fig. 7,55) which curves outwards, and then backwards towards the process of the head upon which the buceal hooks are placed, to terminate according to Krohn, in the muscles by which the hooks are moved, close to which, he says, that each nerve presents a minute ganglionic enlarge- ment from which several filaments are given off to be distri- buted to the muscles. The posterior pair of nerves arising from the cephalic gang- lion (fig. 7, ¢ c) pass backwards, in a divergent direction, and terminate in a rounded ganglionic mass, in the centre of which the eye (fig. 7, h) is, as it were, imbedded. These optic ganglia, according to Krohn, are composed of distinct ganglionic cells; but it would appear from Mr. Huxley’s observations, that the optic nerves, as they may be termed, also exhibit a smaller ganglionic enlargement immediately before entering the optic ganglion (fig. 7,2). The optic ganglion and the eye lie in a special closed cavity in the integument of the head. 3. The third pair of nerves arising from the cephalic gang- lion (fig. 7, dd) are given off from the sides of that body, curving backwards and downwards, so as to pass on either side of, and to get beneath the cesophagus, where they approach each other again, and becoming nearly parallel in the mesian line of the trunk, join the ventral ganglion. They constitute, therefore, what may be termed an cesophageal commissure. The ventral ganglion (fig. 8) lies in the middle of the ventral surface of the trunk, also immediately beneath the integument, which is seen to be somewhat elevated by it when the animal is viewed on the side. It is situated between the head and the lateral fins, theugh rather nearer to the latter. It is of an elongated, oval form, and in full-grown individuals about 13 mm. long. There may be distinguished in it a lighter-coloured nuclear or medullary substance (fig. 8, ), which occupies a central tract, and a darker-coloured, coarsely granular cortical layer, composed apparently for the most part of ganglion- globules. Four principal nervous trunks proceed from this ganglion: an anterior pair (fig. 8, d d), which are continuous with the lateral trunks given off from the cephalic ganglion (fig. 7, dd), and constitute the cesophageal commissure ; and a posterior, (fig. 8, ff), which run directly backwards, slightly diverging from each other. These trunks are, upon the whole, stronger and rather shorter than the anterior pair, inasmuch as, according to Krohn, they do not extend much beyond the an- terior pair of lateral fins. He states that each trunk terminates c 2 20 BUSK, ON THE STRUCTURE AND in a sort of cauda equina, composed of numerous minute nervous twigs. From the sides of the ventral ganglion, and according to Krohn, from the nervous trunks also, are given off numerous nerves in rapid succession, which, according to the same observer, curve upwards towards the dorsal surface of the trunk, subdividing into numerous twigs, which anasto- mose, and thus constitute a very intricate plexus beneath the integument. The latter part of this statement may perhaps be erroneous, but at any rate there is no doubt of the fact, that numerous small lateral branches are given off, apparently sym- metrically, from the sides of the ganglion itself, as shown in fig. 8. The Head.—This portion of the animal is distinctly sepa- rated from the trunk, and is surrounded by a sort of mem- branous hood, which is capable of being drawn backwards over it. ‘The upper surface of this hood is level with that of the trunk, whilst the lower forms a plane inclined from above, and anteriorly downwards and backwards. When fully ex- panded, the hood, except inferiorly where it presents, in the middle line, a longitudinal opening for the mouth, appears to envelop the entire head ; when retracted, the head is exposed, particularly on the sides, when the following parts are dis- played. 1. On each side a series of curved pointed hooks, (fig. 3, c), which, when the hood is expanded, close from either side of the mouth, The number of these hooks does not appear to be very constant, and the anterior hooks are usually shorter than the others. 2. Besides these larger buccal hooks there will be observed, at the anterior extremity of the head, two curved series of smaller denticles (fig. 3, a), one behind the other on either side. On each side the inferior surface of the head presents a large, rounded eminence, apparently composed of the muscles by which the buccal hooks are more directly moved, and be- tween these buccal lobes is situated the oval opening in the form of a longitudinal slit or fissure, which is crossed poste- riorly by a kind of fimbriated border, stretching across from one buccal lobe to the other (fig. 3, 0). The pharynx or esophagus commencing at this point is a short tube with thick muscular walls, a little larger in diameter than the intestine, and extending but a short distance beyond the junction of the head and trunk, It is bounded on either side by the buccal masses above noticed. On the upper surface of the head, on either side, and pretty close to the median line, will be seen the “ eyes,” (fig. 7,4). These organs are composed apparently of a mass of black pigment, around the margin of which will be noticed clear points, or cornea, RELATIONS OF SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA. 24 which, according to Mr. Huxley, are disposed in three distinct sets. As has been before stated, the eyes are lodged in the upper surface of the optic ganglia, and contained together with them in special cavities excavated in the integuments of the head. 2. Trunk.—This portion, which constitutes the principal part of the animal, is an elongated hollow sac containing the muscular hands above described, the intestinal canal and ter- mination of the cesophagus, together with the ventral ganglion and its branches, and the ovaries which are situated poste- riorly, The intestinal canal, which commences at the termination of the cesophagus, is a simple, straight, somewhat compressed tube, extending from this point to the junction of the trunk with the caudal portion, where it makes a rather abrupt curve downwards, becomes contracted, and terminates in the anus, which presents the form sometimes of a rounded aper- ture, sometimes more that of an elongated slit, but in either case projecting beyond the surface. The walls of this simple tube are composed principally of a layer of annular fibres, strengthened on the upper and under sides by a narrow band of longitudinal fibres, which, according to Krohn, are situated external to the annular. The tube is lined internally by an epithelium, composed of elongated prismatic cells, furnished, perhaps throughout, with long vibratile cilia. [tis supported in its place above by a continuous median band, and below it is held by numerous slender, usually branched threads, disposed in a line corresponding to the band above. The perigastric cavity is thus imperfectly divided, as it were, into two lateral compartments, The intestinal canal is generally empty, but ina few instances Krohn has seen in it fragments of minute fish and crustacea, and in some cases portions of other Sagitte. The “ caudal portion,” and the ovaries, constitute the sexual apparatus, which will now be described. 1. The female portion of this apparatus consists of two organs, which are situated in the posterior part of the cavity of the trunk, on either side of the terminal portion of the in- testine (fig. 4, a, a, fig. 6). These organs, which may be termed ovaries, in the mature state, are often of considerable size, extending even beyond the upper pair of lateral fins. They are elongated sacs, which are attached by a longitudinal band to the lower wall of the trunk. Inferiorly the ovary curves abruptly upwards and outwards, forming a sort of short oviduct, which opens externally between the upper muscular band and the base of the posterior pair of lateral fins. In the 22 BUSK, ON THE STRUCTURE AND outer portion of each ovary is a dense granular tract (fig. 6, a), the remainder of the cavity being occupied by a more finely granular stroma in which the ova are developed, attached at first by short pedicles to the placental tract. In the outer portion of this tract runs a slender cecal canal, which may be traced close to the opening of the oviduct (fig. 6, 5). This canal, which was first noticed by Wilms (I. c. p. 13, fig. 10), is regarded by Krohn (Wiegm. Archiv. 1853, p. 269), as a receptaculum seminis, seeing that it is occasionally found to be filled with actively-moving spermatozoa. According to Wilms and Huxley, the canal is lined with cilia, but Krohn is of opinion that this appearance of cilia is due to the presence of the motile spermatozoids. The ova (fig. 6, ¢) present no peculiarity, except that Wilms and Krohn concur in stating that a germinal spot is never observed in the comparatively large germinal vesicle. 2. The male apparatus.—The caudal portion of the animal (fiz. 1, d) is divided by a vertical, longitudinal] septum, into two perfectly distinct compartments. These compartments may properly be termed the testes, as it is them that the deve- lopment of the spermatozoa appears to take place, which is thus described by Wilms (l.c. p. 13). In younger individuals, each compartment contains a greater or less number of vesicles of various dimensions, some spherical, others of irregular form, elongated, and ovoid. At first sight they seem to be filled with a sort of granular substance, but when a little larger, are plainly seen to contain minute spherical cells. In animals nearer maturity, besides these cysts, there will also be noticed cells in which, upon the addition of acetic acid, a nucleus is plainly visible. From these aggregations of cells (fig. 9), which are always somewhat less in size than the cysts above noticed, the spermatozoa are developed. At a certain period, slender filaments are seen to proceed from them, causing the appearance as if the cells were beset with spines, whilst others present the appearances represented in fig. 12, a, 6, imdicating a further stage of development. The central cellular mass (shown at a, fig. 12) gradually diminishes in bulk as the filamentary portions become more and more developed (fig. 12 6), and gradually disappears altogether, nothing remaining but bundles of spermatozoids attached to each by their heads. These bundles eventually break up into separate spermatozoids. The mature spermatozoid is a long filament, slightly enlarged at one extremity, beyond which, however, the point is usually prolonged in the form of a very delicate short thread (fig. 11). A remarkable circumstance observable in the spermatic cavities of Sagitta, is the continual cyclosis performed by their RELATIONS OF SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA., 23 contents.* These will be seen constantly ascending on the outer, and descending on the internal wall or septum in the directions indicated by the arrows in fig. 4. The cause of this motion is stated by Krohn to depend upon the presence of scattered cilia in the posterior part of the cavity. The spermatozoids thus formed make their exit from the cavity in a very curious mode. On each side of the caudal portion will be observed a projection, (figs. land 4, e e,) which may, perhaps, be regarded as a sort of ejaculatory apparatus. These processes are hollow sacculi, which open externally by a rounded orifice situated at the upper end, and communicate with the interior of the compartment to which they belong, through a canal excavated in the integuments of the caudal portion. If, as Krohn observes, one of the seminal compart- ments be laid open by a longitudinal incision on the under surface, and the contents carefully removed, an opening sur- rounded by a raised margin will be clearly seen at a short dis- tance from each ejaculatory sac. This orifice leads into the canal above mentioned, which runs along the corresponding border of the upper muscular band, making a slight curve posteriorly, gradually contracting in size, and finally opening in the cavity of the ejaculatory sac. The inner wall of these efferent canals, as well as of the external sac, is lined with an actively vibrating ciliated membrane. With respect to the mode in which the spermatozoids come in contact with the ova nothing is known, though it would seem, if Krohn’s observation above related, of the presence of sper- matozo ain the cecal canal contained in the ovary be confirmed, that they must make their entrance in some way into that organ. It is more probable, however, that the ova are impreg- nated after extrusion; and that this is the case, is rendered the more likely by the circumstance that innumerable sperma- tozoids in the most active motion may occasionally be observed, swarming out of the orifice of what [ have termed the ejacula- tory sac (fig. 5). And it seems scarcely possible that these motile filaments should make their way spontaneously into the narrow and close opening of the oviduct, which they must do in order to reach the canal in question. The Sagitta is obviously oviparous; but with respect to the further development of the ova after deposition, little is known. According to Krohn (Wiegm. Arch. 1853, p. 270), the vitellus consists of numerous cells containing an albuminous fluid, and in which he was unable to perceive any vitelline granules. Jt is surrounded by two membranes. ‘The internal, which * Krohn remarks (p. 13), that a similar movement of the spermatic globules is observed in the testicular vesicles of the Leech. 24 BUSK, ON THE STRUCTURE AND closely envelopes the vitellus, is thin and firm; the proper vitelline membrane, whilst the outer is much thicker, and according to him of a gelatinous consistence, swelling up rapidly when the ova escape into the surrounding water. At a later period it is sometimes absent, although the development is not, according to Krohn, by this interfered with, Mr. Darwin also (1. c.) assigns an outer envelope to the ovum, but it would seem that this envelope was of a firmer consistence than the one described by Krohn, since he states that it is rup- tured soon after the commencement of partial segmentation of the vitellus, which undergoes its further development after it has thus escaped.* Many species of Sagitta are described by different authors, but it would seem that considerable confusion still exists on this subject. One thing appears tolerably certain, viz., that the species common on the British coast, and which is the one here described, is, as before stated, very widely distributed in all seas from the north to south antarctic oceans. And it may well be supposed that superficial observation of specimens at different ages and of different sizes, may have caused an unne- cessary multiplication of species. Krohn, who considers that the number, position, and form * In Siebold and Kolliker’s ‘ Zeitschrift f. Wissens. Zoologie, Bd. v., p- 15, is a short notice respecting the development of Sagitta, by C. Gegenbaur. He states, that the process of segmentation terminates in the production of an embryo of a rounded form, in which two kinds of cell-masses may be recognized,—one central, constituted of minute, and a well-defined peripheral layer, composed of larger cells. A depression is now formed at one point of the surface, which gradually advances to the centre, constituting the rudiment of the intestine. The embryo now appears to increase in length, in consequence of which, since it completely fills the cavity of the ovwm, it becomes bent, and is ultimately coiled in a vermiform fashion. The cavity of the trunk may be distinguished, traversed by the intestine, which forms, as it were, a vertical septum ; but, besides this, no other internal organs are apparent. At this period the embryo often moves, and on the addition of acetic acid the muscular bands in the trunk are visible, completely formed, and exhibiting the fine transverse strice. The fins arise as simple lateral outgrowths of the body. In this condition the animal leaves the oevwm, about ?'" in length, and already presenting in all respects the character of the full-grown Sagitta. The other organs, consequently, are not developed until after the animal has quitted the ovwm. In the entire course of development, many stages of which, particularly those which succeed complete segmentation, are very difficult to be understood, cilia never make their appearance. If the anatomy of this creature had not satisfactorily shown that it belongs neither to the Pteropoda, nor to the Heteropoda—this would have been rendered certain by its mode of development, which does not accord in any respect with the Molluscan type. What the real position of Sagitta is I will not determine. RELATIONS OF SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA. 25 of the lateral fins will afford most useful diagnostic characters, describes the following species :— 1. S. multidentata (Wieg, Arch. 1853, p. 271, Plate 12, fig. 2).—Which in habit closely approaches the S. setosa of Wilms (our S. dipunctata). The posterior fins are longer and wider than the anterior, which extend in front to about the anterior third of the body. The number of hooks is from 9 to 11. That of tke denticles in front of the mouth (fig 3, a), is in the ante- rior row from 5 to 8, and in the posterior from 12 to 13. He notices another form closely resembling the above, but characterized by the existence of a horny, toothed ring around the orifice of the ejaculatory sacs. 2. S. serrato-dentata (1. ¢. figs. 3 and 4).—Which appears to resemble the foregoing in nearly all respects, except in the conformation of the hooks, which are described as serrated on the inner edge for about half their length. The number of hooks is from 6 to 8 on either side. The denticles in the an- terior row are never more than eight in number on each side, whilst in the posterior there are as many as 18. The bundles of rigid sete are disposed symmetrically in eight lateral rows, four dorsal and four on the ventral aspect. It is a very small species, not exceeding 44m. in length. 3. S. lyra (1. ¢., fig. 5).—The caudal portion of the body very short and separated by a groove from the elongated trunk. The two pairs of lateral fins are apparently continuous with each other, and the anterior are much longer than the posterior, and extend far anteriorly, The number of hooks is 6 to 8 on either side; of the denticles, 7 in the anterior and 11 in the posterior series. The bundles of sete are irre- gularly distributed over the surface of the body. It is a large species, attaining the considerable length of from 3 to 34 centim. 4. S. draco (1. ¢., fig. 6).—The body of this rare form is short and thick, and invested for the anterior three-fourths of its length, by a very considerable layer of large, thick-walled cells. The caudal portion is very long, the trunk short, and the caudal fin of large size. The anterior pair of lateral fins is wholly wanting, and the pair corresponding to the pos- terior fins of other species do not extend beyond the caudal portion of the body. The species is remarkable also for the existence of two lateral and opposite bundles of numerous, very long, freely-floating filaments, seated upon special emi- nences, which again are placed upon the cellular layer sur- rounding the anterior part of the body. The filaments are of soft ope ternne ligulate, and constituted of parallel longitu- dinal fibrille. tere are ten hooks on either side; eight 26 BUSK, ON SAGITTA BIPUNCTATA. anterior denticles on each side and 18 posterior. The bundles of rigid set@ are scattered irregularly over the surface. The only individual met with by Krohn was one centimetre in length. Other species described by authors are— 5. S. cephaloptera (Busch, |. ¢., pl. xv., fig. 2).—Distin- guished by a radiated disc on the anterior part of the trunk, and two tentacular processes on the sides of the head. 6. S. rostrata (Busch, 1. ¢., fig. 7).—Distinguished from SS. setosa, Wilms, by the presence of a large rounded eminence on the anterior part of the head, whick Krohn imagines may be caused in a young specimen of a Sagitta by the cephalic ganglion. 7. S. bipunctata, Quoy and Gaimard, which we regard as identical with— 8. S. setosa, Wilms, the species here described, and pro- bably the parent of other species, among which perhaps may be enumerated those named by D’Orbigny (Voyage dans YAmerique Meridionale, tom v., p. 14, Pl. 10) according to the number of their fins, as S. diptera, S. triptera, and S. hez- aptera. If all these really belong to Sagitta at all, which, in the absence of farther information than that given by D’Orbigny, may be regarded as doubtful, S. hexaptera, at any rate, may be considered identical with S. bipunctata. With respect to the systematic position of Sagitta, very considerable difficulties arise in the determination of it. Mr. Huxley (I. c., p. 77) remarks that ‘ Sagitta has been placed by some among the Mollusca, a view based upou certain apparent resemblances with the Heteropoda. These, however, are superficial ; the buccal armature of Sagztta, for instance, is a widely-different structure from the tongue of Firola to which, when extended, it may have a distant resemblance.” ‘“‘ There appears,” he says, “ much more reason for placing this creature, as Krohn, Grube, and others have done, upon the annulose side of the animal kingdom; but it is very difficult to say in what division of that sub-kingdom it may most naturally be arranged.” After surveying the points of resemblance and difference between Sagitta and the nematoid worms and certain Naiada, Mr. Huxley concludes by obsery- ing “ that the study of its development can alone decide to which division of the annulose sub-kingdom Sagitta belongs ; but that until such study shall have demonstrated the contrary, he stated his belief that Sagitta bears the same relation to the Tardigrada and Acaridez that Linguatula (as has been shown by Van Beneden) bears to the genus Anchorella, and that the MAGNIFYING POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 27 young Sagitta will, therefore, very possibly be found to re- semble one of the Tardigrada, the rudimentary feet with their hooks being subsequently thrown up to the region of the head as they are in Linguatula.” Krohn, with much hesitation, is inclined to regard it as belonging to the Annelid group, with which it would certainly at present appear to exhibit a very probable relationship. On the Maaniryinc Power of Suort Spaces illustrated by the Transmission of Ligut through Minute APERTURES. By Joun Goruam, M.R.C.S.E., &e. Havine described in the former papers the appearances observable when pencils of light from small circular apertures are partially intercepted by certain opaque or transparent objects of definite shape and size; and having shown that whether shadows or illuminated spaces are thus used, they serve to exemplify the magnifying power of short intervals existing between the organ of vision and the object to be ex- amined, inasmuch as they occupy some position in space, and have a certain form, qualities which pertain to them in common with all substances appreciable by the sense of sight, we pro- ceed to notice the phenomena which result when exceedingly narrow linear apertures are substituted for those of a circular form. In conducting these investigations it was not unreason- able to suppose, a priori, that if the size, the quality, and the position of the object to be examined, the direction and the intensity of the light which was used, the sensitiveness and immediate response of the pupil of the eye to the minutest variation in the quantity of light impinging on the retina, and the refracting qualities of the transparent portion of the visual organ, were each and all taken into account, so that a nice and delicate adjustment of the eye to the light, and of the light as well as of the size of the objects to the eye could be insured, appearances perhaps beautiful, doubtless uncommon, and cer- tainly interesting to the physiologist might be fairly antici- pated. Such anticipations, have been so far realized as to present a strong inducement to prosecute the subject with a legitimate prospect of still greater success. It is obvious that the phenomena which have occupied our attention are chiefly due to the formation of shadows. For when a divergent pencil of light proceeding from a small cir- cular perforation in a card falls upon the eye, and when a small object either transparent or Opaque—a transparent cross on a black ground, or a black cross on a transparent ground, 28 GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING for instance, is allowed to intervene; it is evident that a shadow of the cross in the latter case, and an illuminated space equivalent to the shadow in size and shape, in the former, is portrayed on the retina of the eye. The same kind of phenomena result even if no artificial body be interposed between the eye and the source of light, the pupillary aperture in this case constituting the transparent space, and the zr7s the blackened margin which gives it outline, so that those rays which are not intercepted by this curtain, pass onwards and ultimately form a picture of the pupil itself at the bottom of the eye. When an opaque object is held either in a beam of light (bundle of parallel rays), or a pencil of light (rays proceeding from or towards some point), it intercepts a portion of the rays, and the space behind the object is in darkness. This dark space is called the shadow of the object. Thus in figure 1, if the luminous body L emits a pencil of light which is stopped in its passage towards the screen by a round piece of blackened pasteboard, O, the dark space between this and the screen, W, is the shadow. Fig. 1. A shadow may be received on a screen held near the object, when its outline will be similar to that of the body by which it is cast. Thus the shadow of the circle O (fig. 1,) is pro- jected as a circle at S, on the white screen W. The breadth of a shadow depends on the direction and dis- posal of the rays of light when they are stopped by the oppo- sing body. These may be parallel, divergent, or convergent. In ‘hel remarks which immediately follow, I shall merely embody so much under each of these heads as relates to the subject of our present disquisition. With respect to parallel rays it is to be observed, that the farther the luminous body is from an object, the less divergent POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 29 are the rays which fall from it upon the object; or the more nearly do they approach to being parallel. ‘‘ From a (fig. 2) there is much divergence, from 6 less, from e less still, and rays from a greater distance, as those represented by d and e, appear parallel. If the distance of the radiant point be very great, they really are so nearly parallel, that a very nice test is required to detect the deviation. Rays, for instance, coming to the earth from the sun, do not diverge the millionth of an inch in a thousand miles. Hence when we wish to make ex- periments with parallel rays, we take those of the -sun.’’* When such rays therefore are intercepted by an opaque body, the breadth of the shadow, for we are not now speaking of its length, is equal to that of the substance. The student in per- spective, is aware of this fact, and the fine effect of a good landscape painting is to be referred in part to the strictness with which this relation is observed by the artist. If the rays are divergent, as when the light-emitting body is very small, a mere point, the shadow is larger than the objcct. Thus if L (fig. 1) be the luminous body, and O the obstacle, the circular figure, S, on the screen, W, being a cross seétion of a shadow which is continually increasing in breadth, is larger than the object O. ‘The shadow of a hand held be- tween a candle and the wall is gigantic; and a small paste- board figure of a man held in a divergent pencil of light, and near its source, throws a shadow as big as areal man. The latter fact has been amusingly illustrated by the art of making phantasmagoric s shadows.” Divergent pencils are easily pro- cured from a pin-hole, a taper, a street lamp, a carriage ‘lamp, &e. When a conver. gent pencil of rays is obstructed by an opaque body, the shadow is smaller than the object, and if not re- ceived on a screen, would taper to a mere point. This is true of the shadows of all the planets, and of the earth, because they are less than the sun. It is exemplified when the moon * See Arnott’s ‘ Elements of Physics.’ 30 GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING falls into the earth’s shadow, and becomes eclipsed, or still better in a solar eclipse, when the moon being at her average distance from the earth, the shadow but just reaches the earth’s surface. Thus if S (fig. 1) represent the sun, and O the moon, that portion of the earth situated at L is in its shadow. The shape of a shadow is regulated by the distance between the object and the screen on which the shadow is received. If this be great, the shadow bears no very definite relation in form to that of the object. On the contrary, it is a mere irre- gular darkened space, the boundaries of which are ill defined and the shape distorted. Thus a leaf at the distance of a yard or two from a wall, will, in the sunshine, give a shadow of in- definite outline, having a round instead of an angular edge: a leaf at a greater distance will produce a mere dimness, with an outline scarcely distinguishable. Instances of a like kind are afforded when the sun’s rays are obstructed by the topmost branches of a tree, or the summit of a tower, or by the inter- vention of passing clouds, which in their passage through the atmosphere contribute so much to the beauty and variety of the natural landscape, and are amongst those fleeting nee ances which elude the vigilance of the pencil. When the screen is at a great distance from the obstacle, as well as from the source of light, the shadow so far from taking the shape of the obstacle, il nasenle that of the luminous body. Thus the shadow of an zrregular body placed in the sun’s light is circular. If on the other hand the object is brought to within a short distance of the screen, its shadow is so clearly defined as to be directly recognized as an exact fac-simile, in shape, of the body itself. A leaf nearly close to the wall casts a shadow of a leaf. “These observations regarding shadows are applicable to the illuminated space formed on a screen by making the sun’s light pass through an aperture.” This will be obvious, on reflecting, that if a shadow or darkened space be well defined, the adjacent, illuminated space must be equally so, and vice versa. For these are contrasted conditions, each of which causes the other to become visible. Neither light alone, nor darkness alone, but only contiguity of both will enable us to appreciate form. Hence light and shade are not only pleasant to the eye, but both are absolutely necessary for the distin- guishing of one object from another. For this reason, pro- bably, the visual organ is ever intuitively on the sends for contrasts either of light, shade, or colour. ‘‘When the screen ae near the aperture, the illuminated portion is similar to the opening ; but when the screen is sufh- POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 31 ciently distant, it is similar to the luminous body. The in- terstices between the leaves of trees are so many small irregular apertures ; hence the cause of the numerous small bright circles seen in a sunny day in the shadow of a tree, or still more dis- tinctly in that of a grove.”’* These simple laws which govern the projection of shadows, and which have been seen to adapt themselves to individual cases, may be easily verified. It is by their judicious combi- nation, however, that we discover the best method of throwing large and well-defined images of small, near objects upon the bottom of the eye, which indeed constitutes the main design of our inquiry. Thus of the three modes of illuminating the object which have been enumerated, that is obviously the best suited to our purpose which casts the broadest shadow. A divergent pencil of light is therefore chosen. mn the next place he position of the screen demands attention, for on this, as we have seen, depends the definition as well as the enlargement of the image. Now in the investigation of small, near bodies, the screen cannot possibly be brought too close to the eye; in- deed it is better to dispense with all artificial substitutes, and to use that kind of screen only which nature has provided. That is to say, the retina of the eye itself. This has accord- ingly been adopted. Again, recollecting the impossibility of distinguishing out- line at all, except by contrast,—a mass of shade bounded by light, or light by shade,—definite contiguous portions of the retina are simultaneously affected with such impressions by using a darkened tube to exclude the light, having small inlets of determined size to regulate its admission at one end, and openings to secure its transmission and exit at the other. In this way, light and dark spaces are brought into direct conti- guity with a well-defined line of demarcation between them. Thus small oljects are appreciable. But, moreover, a shadow, like its substance, appears larger as it approaches the eye; and the amount of enlargement is regulated by the same law. Hence the one is equivalent in this respect to the other: and as a shadow can be projected directly in front of the eye, and received as an image, it is thereby much magnified ; nevertheless at such short distances, both shadow and substance, by any other process, would prove invisible. Here, then, we have within our reach the combination of elements which appear necessary for examining small objects, at very short distances from the eye; namely:—A darkened retina, a diminutive olject less than the pupillary aperture, held * See Chambers’ ‘ Opties,’ p. 14. 32, GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING close in front of the eye, and a small divergent pencil of light. From which it results, that the object when held in this pencil, intercepts a portion of the hight, and so casts a shadow greater than itself, which shadow is rendered visible by contrast, still further magnified by proximity, and eventually forms a visible image at the bottom of the eye. This principle of opposition or dissimilitude of shade, as well as of colouring, called contrast, a term in very general use in painting, is of universal application, because it contributes not to the beauty only, but to the visibility of all objects. Whether these opposite and contiguous colours or shades are seen at the same time, and that this gives rise to the effect of which we are all sensible, as is generally supposed, or whether it results from attentively looking at the one and then at the other in rapid succession, as was insisted upon by Sir Charles Bell, it is not our province now to inquire, although there are reasons for believing that both of these theories are correct, and that the former holds good for minute objects near to the eye, while the latter applies to larger ones at greater or com- mon intervals. Dismissing hypothesis, however, we know that with respect to bodies viewed at ordinary distances, if a white figure be delineated on a white ground, or a black figure on a black ground, neither is visible; in the first there is no shade, and in the second no light, consequently there is no con- trast. But the slightest variation of shade in the figures in relation to their respective grounds, is sufficient to render each of them definite. Hence the effect of a well-executed en- graving, in which, although no colour is introduced, but merely white and black to imitate light and shade, the appearance is natural and satisfactory. Two simple experiments will serve to show the importance of attending to contrast with respect to the examination of very near objects. By the first it is seem that although a well- defined image is known to be certainly received on the retina, it is invisible when the retina and it happen to be equally illumi- nated. For this purpose, let perforations with a needle, the tenth of an inch apart, and arranged in the form of a circle of about a quarter of an inch in diameter, be made in a piece of blackened cardboard (fig. 3). When brought close to the eye, these apertures appear as a ring of luminous circles (fig. 4), the remaining part of the retina being in darkness. If now around piece be cut out from the centre of the first card, a portion as large, for instance, as that which is traced in outline, but not actually excised in figure 3, so as to admit light through the very middle of the perforated circle; it will be found that while the discs are known to be still received on the POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 33 retina of the eye as circles, inasmuch as the perforations remain intact, and their position unaltered, they are not perceived as such, because the surface at the bottom of the eye on which the inner half of each falls is illuminated. Hence they appear as semicircles (see fig. 5). Fig. 3 Fig. 5. From which it is manifest, that however weil defined an object may be, and however assured we may feel that its image is actually portrayed on the bottom of the eye, it ts not recog- nised unless the contiguous surfaces are oppositely affected with respect to light and shade. The second experiment is the converse of the last, and goes to prove that an image is visible only when the retina of the eye and the object are unequally illuminated. Let that portion of a common sewing-needle which contains the eye be mounted on a slip of glass as if for the microscope; and let the paper with which it is covered, have a very small circular aperture through which to examine it, thus (fig. 6) : Fig. 6, On holding the object close to the naked eye, it is found to be altogether invisible. Nothing is seen but vacant space. It is matter of certainty, however, that the front rays are in- tercepted, and that a shadow of the needle is therefore really formed, but before reaching its destination, lateral rays stream into the eye in all directions, which neutralise the shadow, and so nothing is seen (fig. 7). VOL. LV. D o4 GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING But when these lateral superfluous rays are excluded by using a divergent pencil of light only, as in the diascope, the shadow becomes visible ; and not only is the exposed portion of the body of the needle seen, but its eye is well defined, and both appear considerably magnified (fig. 8). Fig. 7. Hence we may safely assume that all small bodies, whether transparent or opaque, are undistinguishable when held close to the naked eye, in broad day-light, or diffused light of any kind, but that if it were possible to distinguish them while in this position, they would appear magnified; and moreover, that this may actually be effected in many instances by the artificial contrivances to which we have been endeavouring to direct attention. Fig. 8. If a single object be retained in a given position before a screen, it will intercept the rays emitted from any number of separate luminous bodies, or sources of light, situated in front of it, and so cast as many shadows. In this way the shadows are multiplied. Thus if a finger be held within an inch or two of the wall, and a number of tapers at as many yards, the pencils of light from the tapers crossing the finger in different direc- tions, and being intercepted by it, an equal number of shadows are cast on the wall at intervals, related to the position of the POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 35 taper. And if an opening of given shape were substituted for the opaque object, as many illuminated spaces would be pro- jected on the wall instead of the shadows. This is effected on a small scale in the diascope, where small perforations which admit the light are substituted for the tapers, transparent designs on glass for the object, and the retina of the eye for the screen on the wall. Beautiful combinations on a large scale might be projected on an extended surface by the multiplication of shadows, but it is not our purpose to examine bodies at ordinary distances. Hitherto but few experiments have been instituted for the purpose of showing what kinds of images are produced with- out a lens by bodies held close in front of the eye. It is not likely, therefore, that all the necessary conditions shall be de- vised until more care and attention shall have been bestowed on this interesting branch of optics. "Those which have been mentioned in the former papers, and are resumed in this, may possibly prove sufficient to provoke inquiry, inasmuch as they are based on legitimate conclusions from the known laws of optics, and are confirmed by experiments. Small circular, as well as elongated openings for the trans- mission of light were used by Grimaldi, Newton, Fresnel, and Frauenhofer for investigating the phenomena, which light pro- duces, when passing near the edges of bodies, a branch of optics which is called the inflexion, or the diffraction of light. A divergent beam of light was obtained by causing the sun’s rays to pass through one of these apertures, and it was ascertained that the shadows of all bodies whatever, held in this light, were not only surrounded, but encroached on by fringes of colours. The experiments themselves were instituted for the purpose of ascertaining the magnitude, form, colour, and number of such fringes, when examined either by common or by homo- geneous light. The aperture, moreover, was held six feet or upwards from the eye, and the fringes were seen either by throwing them on a smooth white surface, where they could be examined with the naked eye, or by looking at them with a magnifying glass, in which case their peculiarities could be more carefully in- vestigated. According to Sir David Brewster, this curious property of light was ably and successfully investigated by Fresnel, but the finest experiments on this subject are those of Frauenhofer.* * See Sir David Brewster’s ‘ Optics,’ Cabinet Cyclopzedia ; also Herschel’s ‘'l'reatise on Light,’ § 735 ; also Edinburgh Cyclopedia, art. ‘Optics,’ vol. xv., p. 856; also ‘ Elements of Natural Philosophy,’ by Bird and Brooke. D2 36 GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING The experiments illustrative of these curious phenomena in which the light becomes bent into hyperbolic curves when passing near the edges of bodies, present nothing in common with those which form the subject of the present paper, in which the short space which is caused to intervene between the eye and the light precludes the possibility of detecting the coloured fringes, supposing indeed that these were the ob- jects of which we were in search, The only point of resem- blance between them consists in the minuteness of the aper- tures through which the light is admitted, and this serves to show that by the same simple means different ends may be accomplished. The mere peeping through a pin-hole without some definite purpose,—some object to be examined,—some particular theory to be investigated, were indeed a childish oc- cupation, It is more than probable that some of the followers of Newton were not much better engaged when we find the celebrated Goethe afterwards using the Geore. si per foramen exiguum, somewhat tauntingly in Beloneade to the fact of their so frequently introducing this term into their writings. ‘he curious figures now about to be described, and which are produced by the transmission of light through minute narrow apertures, although related to those which have been shown to result from mere perforation, contrast with them, nevertheless, in several important particulars, of which not the least striking, 3 is the production of quadrangular planes which are formed when the light is partially intercepted during its passage towards the eye, and which when multiplied by i in- creasing the number of lines which produce them, appear to fall together at their edges, and so to resemble hollow semi- transparent figures of considerable beauty. It may not be withheld, however, that this part of our sub- ject is, so far as 1 have yet proceeded, circumscribed within narrow limits, being restricted chiefly to the formation of images on the retina of the eye, of those solids known as paral- lelopipeds, with composite forms, resulting from the multipli- cation of the simple ones. The peculiar feature in the experi- ments, consisting not so much in the novelty of the forms themselves, as in their mode of production, We proceed to consider the phenomena which light presents when introduced through a narrow aperture held at a short interval of an inch or two from the eye. When an exceedingly small transparent space or aperture* * Lines for this purpose may be drawn on glass, or cut through tin-foil. When the former process is adopted, a small round disc of Indian ink is laid on a circular piece of very thin glass, such as is used for the cover of microscopic objects, and which may be procured of any microscope maker, POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 37 made on glass, or in tin-foil, is held at the end of a darkened tube about two inches long, andl examined by placing the eye at the opposite end, and looking either at a white cloud or a window blind on a sunny day, or at a lamp with a ground glass shade, it appears altered in size, shape, and transparency. In order to illustrate this, ond to give an idea of the image thus formed on the retina of the eye, let AA (fig. 9) be one of these apertures fixed in the end of a darkened tube T, and let AC, AD be rays of light admitted through it. This light will diverge in lines AC and AD, and form an image CD at the bottom of the eye. If the same aperture be removed a few inches farther from the eye, it presents nothing remarkable, and in no wise differs in appearance from what we know to be its real form, namely, a transparent line of exceedingly smal] dimensions. But if it be again made to approach the eye, it will appear, first, to be much magnified ; secondly, to have lost its rectangular outline, and to become rounded at either extremity ; and thi irdly, to be traversed by dark bands which take a MivetitGn pari allel to its long axis, as shown in figure 9, Fig. 9. These glass covers are sold by the ounce, and are cut into squares or circles of various sizes for the convenience of mounting. The Indian ink might be painted on the glass by hand; but, after having made several eross of such black discs, the author of these papers strongly recommends a little instrument which, although constructed for a totally different purpose, answers most admirably for this. It is the invention of Mr. Shadbolt, and is described and figured in the second edition of Quekett’s ‘ Treatise on the Microscope,’ p. 289. This instrument is nothing more nor less than a miniature horizontal turning lathe, which is worked by the finger, and by which, with the assistance of a camel’s-hair pencil, the ink may be laid on in circles with the greatest nicety and expedition. When dry the narrow line is erased with a finely meyies and slightly moistened one-nibbed quill; or, what is better, a style of brass drawn along a flat ruler. When tin-foil is used instead of glass, it may be held on a piece of smooth flat lead; an aperture of the required size can then be cut completely through with the point of a penknife. 38 GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING The magnitude of the image is of course due to the proxi- mity of the object to the visual organ, the rounded appearance of its ends to the circular form of the pupillary aperture, while the dark bands are produced by interference. ‘These pheno- mena claim a more attentive examination. That the apparent magnitude of the luminous space is so increased that the latter loses its linear form, and becomes a plane, is only another example indeed of the general law in optics, that all bodies, without exception, appear to grow larger as they approach the eye, and to diminish as they recede from it. But here an objection may be naturally raised by one who has not familiarised himself with such inquiries, or with the refracting powers of the eye. He finds from direct observation, opportunities for which occur daily, that remote objects do appear diminished in accordance with the law to which we have referred, and with respect to objects at such distances, he is inclined therefore to acquiesce in its correct- ness. But on holding a small body, a needle we will suppose, close to the eye, he is disappointed on discovering not only that it is not magnified, but that it is altogether invisible. Such an experiment has doubtless been performed by many, and from its failure it has been concluded, and not without an appearance of reason, that the body was held too near to the eye to be visible, which however is not the case, as we have endeavoured to show in a former experiment. But this very failure indicates the necessity of means to an end. For if having satisfied ourselves theoretically that the eye is endowed with certain capabilities, which we have reason to believe there is a possibility of developing ; and if, on the application of certain known laws in optics, some definite figure which it was anticipated should certainly result, does not make its appearance, we are driven to the conclusion, that the failure is attributable to the experiment itself. A fresh trial, however, is perhaps crowned with success, and it is thus that we become possessed of new optical instruments, the value of which is directly proportionate to the importance of the laws they are designed to illustrate. For what are all optical instruments, The glass or tin-foil should now be mounted on a piece of cardboard of the required dimensions to fit the diascope, and having a hole about one quarter of an inch in diameter punched from its centre. For this purpose the thin tracing paper used by architects is the best, as it answers the double purpose of keeping the glass in its place, and preventing too much light passing through the apertures. The dimensions of these apertures should be about the 1-15th of an inch by the 1-185th of an inch, or nine times as long as broad (9: 1 23 qs ¢ 733). These dimensions can be easily ascertained by a micrometer with the aid of a microscope. POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 39 but material combinations which serve to elucidate funda- mental principles in optics by direct experiment ? When one of these apertures, only the 1-200th of an inch broad, is brought close to the eye, its apparent size is abcut two ches *Phis is easily proved by observing that the breadth of its image covers that of a line two Plies long, held up for the purpose of comparing the two at an Seal of ten inches, the distance at which we are accustomed to view ordinary objects in order to gain an idea of their sup- posed extension in space, and so to guess at their real magni- tude. If this distance of ten inches were always preserved, and if surfaces whose real dimensions are required were always compared with a scale held at such a distance, the eye might become instructed to appreciate relations of magnitude with ea greater accurac yi than it has hitherto attained. The comparison of the image of a very small object in close proximity to the eye, with that of any larger object at the usual distance for distinct vision, thus affords a correct method of measuring the apparent iqeeaced magnitude of all small bodies; and it cannot be too strongly impressed on the mind, that on looking through any aperture, whether small or eae it always appears as large as all we see through iit: This has been happily expressed by an eminent writer. “‘ If you shut one eye and hold immediately before the other a small circle of plain glass, of not more than half an inch in diameter, you may see through that circle the most extensive prospects, lawns and woods, and arms of the sea, and distant mountains, You are apt to imagine that the v ble picture you thus see is immensely great ae extensive ; but it can be no greater than the visible circle through which you see it. If, while you are looking through the circle, you could conceive a fairy hand and a fairy pencil to come between your eye and the glass, that pencil might delineate upon that little glass the oielines of all those eee lawns and woods, and arms of the sea, and distant mountains, in the dimescaane in which they are seen by the eye.’ Since this was penned, the fairy hand and the fairy pencil have both been actually discovered in the beautiful art of photography. 2. The extremities of the aperture appear rounded or semi- circular.—We have seen how a circular perforation considered as aradiant point admits a divergent pencil of rays, the cir- cular base of which forms a large round disc or image at the bottom of the eye (fig. 10). Now as a line mathematically considered is made up of a number of points, so a transparent line may be assumed to consist of a number of radiant points, AO GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING each of which lying side by side in a linear direction will produce exactly such a series of overlapping circles at the Fig. 10. bottom of the eye (fig. 11). Hence a small, narrow, transparent slit for the transmission of light when brought very near to the organ of vision, forms an image not of a line but of a plane rounded at either extremity. Fig. 11. 3. The area of the aperture appears to be traversed by longi- tudinal dark bands.—* If we hold the hand between the eye and a bright cloud, or the ground-glass of a lighted lamp, and open the fingers so as to adnate the smallest portion of light, we shall perceive similar dark bands intersecting the Inuaietonts space at regular intervals.” * The explanation of this phe- nomenon is founded on the interference of light, which, according to the undulatory theory, takes place uae the un- dulations meet in opposite phases; these being superposed produce darkness. We have now to examine the appearance of bodies held close to the eye, and in the light admitted through small linear apertures such as we have been describing. * See Woodward, on ‘ Polarized Light.’ POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 41 Bearing in mind that the image of a linear aperture is not a line but a plane, and that this can be revolved by inserting it in the distal end of the drascope, it will be seen that if the object chosen for examination be a similar linear aperture held close to the eye we obtain a second plane, the first of which can be revolved in front of the second, and so the two can be made to intersect at any angle. In order to illustrate this, let the planes P ard p (fig. 12), Fig. 12. about two inches apart, be inserted at the ends of a darkened tube, and let a small linear aperture, a and d, be made in each of them. Now by revolving the plane p, the one aperture will intersect the other. When common diffused light is admitted through the further aperture d, the greater part is intercepted in its passage towards the eye at E by the plane P, but that which is transmitted will partake of the form of the luminous space produced by the intersection of the two. Thus when the apertures cross at a right angle, as shown in the figure, the image which meets the eye is a square, while it is rhombic at all other angles. This may be further illustrated by cutting two oblong pieces, exactly similar in shape and size, from the lid and the bottom of a common pill-box. When the former is revolved upon the latter, the quadrangular planes to which we have referred are easily imitated (fig. 13). Hence by holding two very nar- row, linear apertures before the eye, and examining them by diffused light, all idea of mere linear exten- sion is lost, and we obtain images of the square and all possible varie- ties of the rhomb. It is worthy of notice that such planes do not differ in form Fig. 13. 42 GORHAM, ON THE MAGNIFYING from the modifications which a square undergoes in obedience to the laws of zsometric perspective ; and it is obvious that if we are enabled to form any kind of rhombic plane at plea- sure, by the mere revolution of one narrow transparent line upon another, we can by simply multiplying these lines mul- tiply also the planes, which when united at their edges will present every appearance of a geometric solid. nd as a single line held close to the eye appears by in- tersection as a single isolated rhomb, so two or more such lines will form as many images, the relative position of which, as well as their number, can be regulated by that of the aper- tures which produce them. If, for example, three fine transparent lines are projected in the form of an equilateral triangle, sufficiently small to be enclosed within the boundaries of a circle not bigger than the pupil of the eye (fig. 16), and if such an object be held close to the eye, and examined by the light admitted through the single aperture at the distal end, its image will be that of the triangular prism (see fig. 21, Pl. [V.). On revolving the distal end of the instrument, which con- tains the single aperture, the prism will appear in a variety of aspects, four of which are shown in the figs. 21, 22, 23, 24, Pl. 1V., in which the image is depicted as seen at each quarter of the circle. In order to insure the proper effect, it is essential that each object (that which is held at the near or ocular extremity of the instrument) shall be mere transparent outline (figs. 14 to 20), in contradistinction to many of those which were exa- mined by the light from the circular perforations, and which consisted of considerable surfaces of illuminated space. A few of the outlines, which I have found to bring out the most satisfactory results, are given in the annexed figures (figs. 14 to 20), Fig. 14. Fig. 15. Fig. 16. Fig. 17. Fig. 18. Fig. 19. Fig. 20. Fig. 14. The straight line. 15. Two straight lines meeting at 60°. 16. Three straight lines meeting at 60° (the equilateral triangle). 17. Four straight lines meeting at 90° (the square). 18. Four straight lines meeting at 60° and 120° (the rhomb). 19. Six straight lines meeting at 120° (the regular hexagon). 20. The circle. The first of these objects is converted into the rhomb or the POWER OF SHORT SPACES. 43 square, the second into two rhombs which are united at their edges, the third forms the triangular prism, the fourth presents an image of the cube, the fifth of the rhombohedron, the sixth of the regular hexagonal prism, while the seventh forms a very beautiful image of the cylindrical tube. All these figures appear hollow, and their terminal planes are filled in by the imagination. Hitherto we have assumed the existence of a single linear aperture at the distal extremity of the instrument, and hence the production of a single image; but we can by increasing the number of the apertures multiply the images, just as when an object is held in the pencils of light proceeding from many simple perforations, and from the same cause. The relative position and distance of the apertures will also regulate the disposition of the images ; thus if they are arranged at regular intervals the images will be so also, and if in rays proceeding from a common centre the images will radiate in like manner. Several composite forms of considerable beauty are thus produced. If, for example, a small hexagon drawn in transparent out- line (fig. 19), be viewed in the light admitted Fie. 21. through several alternating and equidistant linear z apertures, thus (fig. 21), there will be seen the images of as many regular hexagonal prisms having the same relative position ; and the result- ing compound form will present a beautiful honeycomb appearance, as in the following figure (fig. 22). If a transparent circle in outline (fig. 20) is substituted for the hexagon, the resulting form presents an analogous arrange- ment of cylindrical tubes, as in fig. 23. Fig. 22, Fig. 23. Sores / p Were I not afraid of tiring the patience of my readers, I might here proceed to describe and delineate a considerable variety of beautiful figures, which are produced when the apertures at the most distant extremity of the instrument are tinted with different colours. The introduction of tints in 44 WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. this way merely modifies and does not alter the results, and sufficient has been said in the former papers to show that the beauty of each image is much enhanced by the process. But Iam not unmindful that, however interesting the results of these simple experiments with mere transmitted light may be to myself, it would be encroaching on the pages of the ‘ Micro- scopical Journal’ to enter more into detail on this part of my subject. Neither does it appear desirable to attempt to give an air of importance to a set of phenomena which, saving that they constitute legitimate illustrations of the subject in hand, have at present scarcely more than their novelty and beauty to recommend them. Nores and Opservations on the Sar-Circutation of Pants. By F. H. Wennam. Since my communication in the last number of this Journal, “On the Circulation of the Sap in the Leaf-cells of the Anacharis Alsinastrum,’ 1 have continued some investigations on non-aquatic plants, with the view of ascertaining the relation or analogy, that the phenomena of their circulatory movements display, towards the subject of my former paper, and to each other respectively. I must, however, remark in the first place, that the ex- amples have been examined in a very random ianner, for I take up the microscope at uncertain periods, merely as a means of recreation, and make no pretensions to that order and system, which alone would allow the efforts of my pen, to find a place with those of a scientific and professed botanist. I am merely desirous of recording some facts which I believe have not before been noticed. The movements of circulation are best seen in the hairs of plants, as the transparency and uniformity of their substance allows their internal mechanism to be very readily distin- guished. I had commenced a list of the most remarkable, and after extending the catalogue to upwards of one hundred, I concluded that the difficulty was to find the exceptions, for hairs taken alike from the loftiest Elm of the forest, down to the humblest weed that we trample beneath our feet, plainly exhibit their circulation. Even hairs from the upper surface of a blade of common Couch Grass (Agropyrum repens) display the sap-movement with singular beauty and distinctness, considering the minuteness of the object; (the intermediate diameter being less than 1-1000th of an inch). The particles WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. 45 may be seen traversing straight from the base towards the apex of the hair, and returning again by the opposite side. The circulation in the hairs of the Groundsel (Senecio vulgaris) was first announced by Mr. Holland, as a discovery made by his triplet microscope, and it isa ioaawbables instance of what his instrument was capable of performing, for out of the multitude of vegetable hairs in which the sap-motion can be seen, I consider tha to be one of the most difficult ; for with our best compound microscopes, it requires careful ma- nagement, and a trial of several fresh specimens before it can be shown satisfactorily. Hairs that exhibit circulation may be taken from all parts of the plant, as the leaves, flowers, stalks, and fruit, and even from the ripening seed-pods as in the Snap- -dragon (Antirrhinum) and White Mustard (Sinapis alba), &e. Tris important that the specimens should be gathered from a portion of the plant, in a healthy and vigorous state of growth. The time is also of some consequence, the motion of the sap being generally most rapid about mid-day. The specimen must ee examined as soon as possible, and the hairs detached without touching them, by tearing them off with a portion of the cuticle of the plant to which they are attached, by means of a fine-pointed forceps. If the hair itself is grasped the destruction of its vitality is the usual consequence. The object should be instantly placed in a th/n glass compressor with clean water, using a good eighth object-glass and an achromatic condenser having a series of diaphragms. Daylight is infinitely superior to artificial illumination, and I have found it much preferable to use a right-angled prism instead of the ordinary plane mirror, In cold dull weather, a well-known object will sometimes fail to exhibit its circulatory movements; in such a case, it may be called into activity by means of the natural stimulus of heat. In applying this the object need not be removed from the microscope, as a stream of hot air may be blown on to the upper or under surface of the thin covering glass, until the sap current is seen to move, by means of a metal blowpipe, or the stem of a tobacco-pipe, previously heated in the flame of a spirit-lamp. Some plants always require the application of an increased temperature, in order to show their circulatory movements. The hairs of the Helianthus are a good example of this. In the hairs of the numerous variety of plants that display the sap-circulation, each species exhibits somewhat different and peculiar esis which may be considered, in a degree, characteristic throughout the plant; in some, sinsle Were “ 46 WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. sap-currents extend the entire length of the cells or hairs, and in others they are divided into an irregular network of ramifica- tions, which shift their positions with considerable celerity, the diversity of the phenomenon, perhaps, depending in some measure, upon the constitution and fluidity of the sap, for where this is rather glutinous the current traverses in the form of a sluggish uniformly moving sheet or layer, lining large portions of the interior of the cell ; I may mention hairs from the Elder (Sambucus niger) as an instance of this. In all cases where the sap-motion is seen in the hairs of a plant, the leaf-cell displays analogous peculiarities, provided the cuticle is not too opaque, or strongly marked to obstruct vision. The cells are best obtained, by tearing off a layer of the cuticle from the stalk or midrib of the leaf, and must then be examined as speedily as possible, for the specimen loses its vitality much sooner than the hairs. There is scarcely a portion of a leaf-cuticle possessing the requisite trans- parency, taken from any plant wherein I have not discovered indications of circulation; even where there is no direct motion of particles to be seen, on account of their minuteness, the existence of circulation may still be known, from the fol- lowing fact:—The active corpuscles, which are the primary cause of all the circulatory movements, are remarkable for their high refractive power, both on their completion, and in different stages of formation, and when arranged in a moving train, they appear as bright lines across the cell.* Many specimens of leaf-cuticle, in which at first no move- ments whatever can be discovered, exhibit these lines, which * As these observations were intended to be exclusively confined to the sap-circulation, I have been desirous of recording them in the simplest manner possible, and have therefore avoided technical expressions ; what I have termed ‘the investment of active corpuscles,” has been known as ‘ protoplasm,” or ‘ cell-mucus.” It may be doubted whether these terms are strictly applicable, or truly represent that which in reality consists of a multitude of particles, possessing individual activity and differing in size, and probably in chemical constitution, according to local position and the variety of plant-substance and tissue with which they are ultimately destined to combine, such as cellulose, and the loose con- tents of the cell, as chlorophyll- and starch-granules, the latter being most evidently formed by the successive deposit of external layers upon a central nucleus. I may also remark, that it was formerly supposed, and some even now retain the same opinion, that the ‘ circulation,” “ rotation,” ‘ gyration,” or ‘‘cyclosis,” in the vegetable cell, both in its early development, or growing stages, was in some way connected with a central nucleus, also kept in rotation, and termed the ‘ cytoblast.” I consider this supposition to be entirely fabulous, for whenever I have occasionally observed such a nucleus, it has either been formed by an accidental conglomeration of some of the cell contents, or by morbid conditions. WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. AZ on being carefully watched, are seen to alter their relative positions, a condition evidently depending upon progressive motion. Most leaf-cells, of course, contain chlorophyll-gra- nules; I have occasionally seen a few of these kept in a continual motion by the sap-currents, but never in any in- stance with the same degree of vigour and constancy, as in aquatic plants. In the cells of the common Plantain (Plan- tago) a few chlorophyll-granules are sometimes seen in motion. This plant furnishes an excellent object, as the cuticle from the stalk or midrib of the leaf shows circulation, both in the hairs and cells at the same time; the sap-motions round the latter are occasionally quite as plainly seen as in the Anacharis, but more frequently the current is one of extreme tenuity, and travels round the cell-wall with great velocity. In the cells of the Horse Thistle (Cnicus) I have also seen the chlorophyll-granules carried along with considerable vigour by the sap-currents: this plant exhibits a remarkable variety in the phenomena of circulation. The glutinous corpuscles are connected together in the form of a line, or rope stretched across the cell, exhibiting a loose vibratory motion as if it were being shaken at one end, while particles and, occasionally, chlorophyll-granules, are carried forward in a manner resem- bling beads along a string. Havi ing now noticed some of the distinguishing peculiarities of the Ppeulstiaa in a few of the plants that have come under my observation, I will offer some brief remarks on the vital principle of vegetable growth and motion. I had stated in my former paper that the cell-circulation, or what is termed “rotation,” in the Anacharis, is entirely caused by the com- bined effort of a multitude of active corpuscles; the same fact equally applies to every other plant that J have examined ; and subsequent experience has given me some further insight into the nature of these atoms; they evidently derive their origin and formation from the most fluid portion of the sap, math which every cell is filled, and which pervades all other portions of the plant tissues. In every stage of their growth they individually possess the motion peculiar to active mole- cules, but when in combination in their containing cell, this motion zs converted into one of direct progression from some cause that I am not able to explain. I have tried by various means to effect a similar motion artificially in ducts and tubes, with both organic and inorganic active molecules, but without success ; I therefore conclude, that the progressive movement is not due to any mechanical conversion of one force into another, but arises from some unknown property, connected with the vitality of the plant. I have witnessed the effect in 48 WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. numberless instances in both the cells and bairs of plants. An isolated active corpuscle is seen detached, quickly per- forming its vibrations with constant activity, until its progress becomes arrested by one of the various ramified currents which traverse the hair; at which instant the vibratory movements totally cease, and the particle visibly assists the direct-forward motion of the current by its vital energy. I observed with regard to the Anacharis, that after having been kept in a cold, dark place for one or two days, usually not a symptom of circulation could be discovered, the cor- puscles having collected together in heaps, with the component particles in a state of torpidity, and on being again exposed to the stimulus of light and heat, they recommenced their active motions. This effect is still more remarkable in some non-aquatic plants ; and a practised eye may at once detect, by the state of the cell-contents, whether the plant is in a state of repose or hybernation, as the corpuscles will in this case be seen collected together in several gelatinous-looking clots, their dormant vitality being again called into existence, by the same method as described for the Anacharis. Light is also quite as necessary a stimulus as heat; for in a recent experiment on this plant I interposed four thicknesses of blue glass between the achromatic condenser, and luminous source, (bright skylight,) thus entirely intercepting the heating rays, and yet, in spite of this intervening obstacle, speedily suc- ceeded in exciting the movements of circulation. The microscope discovers that in every portion of the plant each duct, cell, or vesicle, that is filled with sap, also contains active corpuscles, apparently differing in dimensions and substance according to locality. As regards the office that these bodies fulfil, it may be inferred that either they are the vehicles that convey nourishment to different portions of the cell-tissues, or that they themselves are deposited, to form the various structures of the plant. I will give an illustra- tion of the latter effect. "The annexed woodcut represents one of the hairs or spines taken from the stalk of the Anchusa paniculata (Boraginacee), an ornamental flowering plant of rapid growth. The growth of the spine is performed by the addition of successive layers to the interior, as shown at @, a, which eventually fill up the apex and render it solid: the method by which this action takes place is as follows:—A dense current of corpuscles are seen to travel along one wall of the spine, constantly returning by the opposite side, repre- sented at bb. Ate, where the deposition occurs, there is a considerable accumulation, and at the boundary, where they are converted into the substance of the spine, a number are WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. 49 seen to be adherent. Some are but recently deposited, while the underlying ones are in various regular stages of transition, gradually losing their form and outline, and finally all traces of individuality become lost ; and by a species of induration the particles become united and identified, with the solid body of the spine. In very many specimens of this object ,_ that I have submitted to examination, the deposit has been so rapid, that there was not sufficient time for the complete con- densation of the component corpuscles. In these instances a number of them have been caught and loosely enclosed in one or more cavities, as shown at dd, and, with the exception of being perfectly motionless, the contained corpuscles are the exact counterpart of those circulating in the spine. The walls of the containing cavities do not possess a definite outline, because they are lined with corpuscles in all their transition stages. I have now brought forward the chief : substance of my notes on this subject; %—}: they were made without previous study, and with an intention to avoid all hypo- thesis, and to confine myself to as clear a description as I could give, of any facts that the microscope might reveal. There is yet very much to be learned respecting the sap-circulation of plants, particularly in their different organs ; but the inquiry is attended with much difficulty, from the necessity of our being compelled to examine detached and lacerated specimens. In many ex- amples this is not of material consequence, as in some aquatic plants, for in these the cells retain their independent motions and individuality, long after their separation; but in non- aquatic plants the case is somewhat different, for the mutual dependence of neighbouring cells is so considerable, that in many instances, death is the immediate result of detaching them, and the movements immediately to be seen under the microscope, are probably only the lingering remnants of vitality, and do not perfectly represent the circulation in the uninjured plant. VOL. IV. E re i (SES R EES Sa aie a ae re a ee Sire at S Saye oO Sa a » umes Yntoy sere z ie r= ~ ~ss t 50 WENHAM, ON THE SAP-CIRCULATION OF PLANTS. Lest it should be imagined, that I advocate the long-ex- ploded theory, that supposed all vitality to originate with active molecules, I will venture, in conclusion, to make a few brief remarks in relation to them. The existence of active molecules has been known in a very early age of the micro- scope, but the first definite information on the subject, was given in the paper of Dr. Robert Brown, published in the ‘ Edinburgh Journal of Science,’ for July, 1828. These observations rather tended to favour the above theory than otherwise, from the circumstance of his connecting together, without due distinction, both inorganic and organic molecules, some of the latter being obtained from actual living plants. The difference between vital and inorganic molecules is im- mediately perceptible, when submitted to the action of proper tests. Active molecules may be obtained from very many different mineral and inorganic bodies, as sulphur, limestone- rock, ashes, and even burnt clay. Their motions have been successively attributed to the influence of mutual attraction, caloric, and electricity ; I have tried several experiments upon them with these two agents, but without obtaining definite results ; nor am [ yet satisfied with any explanation that has hitherto been given of the cause of their activity. I merely mention this in order to show the very wide difference exist- ing between these and the active molecules, or rather cor- puscles, contained in the vegetable cell; to all appearance their movements are identical, but the motion of the latter may be entirely suspended, or awakened, by the range of temperature consequent upon ordinary atmospheric changes. Their vital activity is immediately destroyed by a small trace of hydrochloric or sulphuric acid. The motion is increased by the agency of a slightly-alkaline solution, particularly that of ammonia; but this stimulant added to excess becomes a poison, and destroys the principle of activity.* On the other hand, active molecules obtained from a pow- dered brick-bat, for example, may be exposed to considerable differences of temperature, without their motions being affected by it; and provided there is no chemical decom- position, they exhibit the same degree of energy, whether the solution be either acid or alkaline. * A fact curiously in accord with what has been observed by Kolliker, with respect to the action of the same re-agents upon the spermatic fila- ments of animals.—Vide ‘ Quarterly Journal of Microscopical Science,’ vol. iii., p. 293.—{ Eps. } CURREY, ON THE PHYTOZOA OF ANTHERIDIA. 51 Hartie on the Puytozoa of AnTuERip1A. By F. Currey, Esq., MA. Was wird aus der Schwiimfaden der Antheridien? Dr. Hartig has devoted a section of his essay on the develop- ment of the vegetable cell, now in course of publication in the ‘ Botanische Zeitung,’ to a consideration of the above question, and the results he has arrived at are highly curious and interesting. Should further investigation lead to a con- firmation of Dr. Hartig’s views, the consequence will be that several genera of the Infusoria must be transferred to the vegetable kingdom. Dr, Cohn’s lately-published observations, will have already prepared the minds of the friends of the Infusoria for such a result, and will cause the blow aimed by Dr. Hartig at the animal nature of some of Professor Ehren- berg’s favourites to be less keenly felt. In the following pages we purpose giving the substance of Dr. Hartig’s paper, which is of great interest to microscopical observers; the experiments are such as may be repeated without difficulty. The author commences by observing that the phytozoa of the Characee are best suited for the observations in question, inasmuch as, when placed upon a slide in water, they are then in their natural element; but numerous observations made upon the Antheridia of Chara, Nitella, Polytrichum, and Marchantia, have \ed to the same results, and the last-named plant has the advantage of affording the easiest opportunity of procuring a large quantity of phytozoa free from the admixture of foreign bodies. To effect this, the disk in which the Antheridia are imbedded should be washed repeat- edly with distilled water, its upper surface removed, and fine transverse sections taken from beneath. If these sections be placed upon a slide in a drop of distilled water, a vast number of phytozoary cells will escape from the segments of the Antheridia into the surrounding water. A dozen, at least, of such sections should be prepared, and in order to prevent evaporation they must be placed upon clean oiled-silk, and covered with bell-glasses lined with moist blotting-paper. If these preparations be examined twice or three times a day, certain changes will be observed to take place in the phytozoa; and since these changes run through the whole mass of the phytozoa in each preparation, they must be considered as normal. The above experiments constantly repeated have led uni- formly to the following results. The free phytozoa are very soon drawn to the edge of the drop of water (probably by the effect of evaporation), and Eee 4 52 CURREY, ON THE PHYTOZOA OF ANTHERIDIA. form there in the first instance a skin which covers the sur- face of the water. The form of the phytozoa is distinguishable in the granulated and serpentine disposition of the “granules of this “skin. Beneath this skin other phytozoa are seen in the state of motion peculiar to them. In the course of a few hours these latter phytozoa assume the form of Ehrenberg’s genera Spirillum and Vibrio differing from that of the phytozoa only in the manifest articulation, and in the absence of cilia. At a later period the granulated Elin extends from the margin over the whole surface of the drop of water, and the phytozoa underneath this skin are now seen, without any cessation of their motion, to assume forms similar to those of the Spirilla and Vibriones. The forms of Vibrio rugula and V. prolifera are most frequent. After the first twelve hours all the phytozoa disappear, and there remain only the Spirilla and Vibriones in number proportionate to that of the original phytozoa., The Spirilla and Vibriones exist for a very short time. After twenty-four hours most of them, after forty-eight hours all of them, have become disanaealeted: The whole drop is now feadercd milky and turbid by numberless globules similar to Monas crepusculum in a state of active motion: The observer may be fully convinced that the forms of Spz- rillum, Vibrio, and Monas, do not originate from extraneous germs, and that they are not formed out of shapeless matter, but that they originate from the undecomposed substance of the phytozoa. The unusual rapidity of the transformations by which the process is kept, as it were, continually before the eye of the observer is a favourable circumstance in these observations. It is an important circumstance that Spirillum does not originate from Monas, but always Monas from Spirillum. After forty-eight hours, it frequently happens that amongst the moving monads which have hitherto been uniformly dis- tributed through the water, small groups consisting of several hundreds of them are to be seen in which the primary active motion has ceased. Shortly afterwards a sharply-defined hyaline skin is formed round these groups, and, as it would seem, by the amalgamation or conjunction of the exterior molecules ; by this? means the young Ameba (Proteus) is formed. This transformation takes place pretty regularly towards the end of the third day. The original size of the Ameba is 1-300" in diameter. In the course fief three or four days it grows to about the size of 1-100". This species differs from the Amebe hitherto de- scribed in the fact that the inner portion of the body which CURREY, ON THE PHYTOZOA OF ANTHERIDIA. 53 bears the granules is much smaller than a certain hyaline covering, which covering is closely attached to the hinder part of such inner portion, but extends far away from the anterior part, and, in addition to this, the progressive motion in this species originates in an alternate enlargement of the longitudinal and transverse diameters, and is so slow as to amount at the utmost to no more than 1-40" per minute. The form of the body resembles that of Am@ba_ princeps (Ehrenberg). The vesicle in the hinder part of the body, which was first described by Ehrenberg as a mouth, and afterwards as an ovarium, is also present. After four or five days the Amaba assumes a spherical shape and becomes motionless, the vesicular body expanding and contracting rapidly as before, in a manner similar to what takes places in many Vorticelle. These spherical mo- tionless Amebe are then for the most part united by a mucilage into groups of from ten to twenty. The mucilage appears to be produced by the decomposition of a cast-off external skin. In about a fortnight after the commencement of the experi- ment a green point appears in the interior of the spherical colourless body of the Ameba; this point gradually increases in size until it fills up the entire hollow of the Ameba, and after becoming covered with a cuticle it escapes in the form of an elliptical bright-green cell, 1-300" in diameter, resembling a Protococcus. It exhibits a round transparent cavity, devoid of chlorophyll, corresponding in size and position to the vesicular body of the Ameba, and resembling at its colourless apex the motile gonidia of Cladophora. A few days later the elliptic or roundish cell lengthens, a formation of trans- verse septa commences, and the uni-cellular alga becomes an articulated one. All these transformations of phytozoa into Spirilla, Vibri- ones, Monads, Amebe, unicellular and articulated Alga, may be observed, not only in the detached phytozoa, but in those which remain in the interior of the sections of the Antheridia. In those Antheridia of which the phytozoa are not fully ripe, the Amebe are seen to originate in the middle of the internal mass of phytozoary cells; some of them make their way out through the softened mass of cellular tissue, but others remain in the interior of the Antheridium until their develop- ment into an articulated Alga. Contemporaneously with Ame@ba, and often earlier, there may be seen amidst the mass of Monads bodies very similar in form and motion to the genus Bodo (socialis), and which increase by transverse division; they have the front end 54 CURREY, ON THE PHYTOZOA OF ANTHERIDIA. furnished with a long whip-shaped antenna or cilium similar to that of Huglena. At their first appearance, their motion, their change of form, and their whole exterior, differ so little from the earliest states of Ameba, that at this period they cannot be distinguished. In these early stages they both resemble Chlamidomonas destruens of Ehrenberg. The above forms uniformly make their appearance, and always in the succession above described. It is true that other forms, such as Uvell@, and even Leptomitee and Peri- coni@, are sometimes met with, the germs of which may have been imported by the atmosphere during the observation, but these organisms, which always appear singly and after the com- mencement of the observation, do not interfere with the above results, when we consider the immense number of the phytozoa and their uniform and contemporaneous transformations. If about a dozen preparations are made, and if they are carefully covered with a bell-glass after each observation, and if care be taken not to extend the observations for too long a time at once, at least half of the preparations will be free from all admixture of foreign organisms. Dr. Hartig proceeds to remark upon certain transformations similar to the above, which occur in the motile gonidia of Cladophora, and he also notices certain Amebe which originate from the phytozoa of the Characee. Want of space prevents us from entering into the details of these latter observations, but it may be observed that in the Amebe of the Characee a remarkable circulation is to be seen similar to that which occurs in the cells of Chara. Diatomacee have been observed to force their way into the interior of these Ameba, and to be carried round with the current of the cell-contents. In con- clusion, the author puts the following questions :—Does Ameba belong to the animal kingdom, or is it a stage of vegetable development? Assuming the latter, does this development ultimately lead to the production of the same plant from which it took its rise, or is the final stage of development dependent upon external circumstances? Are the phytozoa endowed with impregnative powers, and do they only become converted into Spirilla in the absence of those organisms upon which their impregnative powers are ordi- narily exercised ? ON A UNIVERSAL INDICATOR FOR MICROSCOPES, 55 On a@ Universat Inpvicator for Microscores. By J. W. Battery. Iw the ‘ Quarterly Journal of Microscopical Science,’ vol. 1, p. 34, an ingenious contrivance for registering the position of microscopic objects is described by Mr. Tyrrel; a modifica- tion of this, by Mr. Aymot, is given in a subsequent number (l. c., vol. i. p. 301); and a still better arrangement for the same purpose, suggested by Mr. Brodie and applied by Mr. Okeden to his microscope, is described at p. 166 of volume ili. of the same work. The last mentioned device can scarcely be improved upon for convenience; but there is one defect which is inherent to all these inventions, viz., that they are essentially selfish contrivances, of no use to any one but the owner of the particular instrument to which they may be attached. The object of the instrument I propose is more comprehen- sive than that of the “ Finders” above alluded to, being no less than to make a Universal] Indicator, by means of which an observer can so register the position of any number of objects mounted upon slides, that when these are sent to a distant correspondent the latter may be able by means of the Indicator to find at will any of these objects, as easily as if he had the identical microscope and “ Finder” by which they were at first recorded. If such a mode of recording the position of objects can be generally adopted that when the register is once made, the record and the objects shall then be entirely independent of the original instrument and observer, and applicable to any microscope, it will tend to promote science not only by facili- tating the interchange of specimens among naturalists, but it will give to each observer’s collection, when properly regis- tered, a permanent scientific value and utility which it could have in no other manner. The plan I have adopted is to make upon an engraved ecard what may be considered as a transferable stage, having guide- lines, by means of which the centre of the field of view of the microscope, and the position of a slide when any object upon it occupies this centre, may be given. Plate V. shows the Indicator complete. The centre of the field of view corresponds to the intersection of the horizontal line C, D, with the vertical line E, F. On the right and left hand of this centre the vertical axes B and A’ are placed at distances of 4-5ths of an inch, and the axes A and B' are - similarly placed at the distances of 6-5ths of an inch from the centre. 56 BAILEY, ON A UNIVERSAL The axes are then graduated as seen in the plate; the small divisions being each 1-50th of the standard inch. The dotted lines G, H, I, give the outline of what will be referred to as the centre-piece. Should it ever be desired to reproduce the Indicator by en- graving or otherwise, the dimensions above given must be most accurately preserved. The dimensions here given were taken from the standard inch of the United States, belonging to the State of New York, and preserved in the office of the Superintendent of Weights and Measures in Albany. It is the same as the English inch. The slides on which objects are mounted to be used with the Indicator must have guide-lines ruled on their under side, as shown in fig. 1 and 2. The horizontal line parallel to the lower edge, and passing through the middle of the slide, is not continued over the portion of the slide which is to be occupied by the objects and their glass cover. The distance of each of the vertical lines from the middle point of the slide is one inch. Great accuracy in the distance between these lines of the slide is not essential when they are to be used with the ordinary form of the Indicator as above given, but it is desirable when they are to be employed as hereafter described, with a modification of the Indicator applied to a moveable stage. The slides should all be marked with an arrow placed upon their upper and right-hand corner, as shown in fig. 1 and 2, to point out the edge which must always be kept in front in using the slides upon the Indicator. The Indicator is to be used as follows :—Cut out the centre- piece with a thin-bladed knife, following the outline G, H,1; then replace the piece cut out, and make a hinge for it along the line G, H, by pasting underneath it a piece of thin paper which will bear repeated folding, so as to connect it to the rest of the card. The Indicator being now ready for use, it must be firmly secured to the stage of the microscope, in such a position that its centre as given by the intersection of the lines C, D, and E, F, when viewed as an opaque object, may be exactly in the centre of the field of view. If the stage is a moveable one, it must be kept stationary after the Indicator is properly centred. The Indicator having been adjusted as above directed, the centre-piece is to be turned down, and the instrument is then ready for use, either to record new objects, or to find those previously recorded. The slide is to be put upon the Indi- cator, and guided either by the fingers or a moveable ruler, so that when any object which is to be registered occupies the INDICATOR FOR MICROSCOPES. 57 centre of the field of the microscope, the horizontal guide-line upon the slides shall pass through the same numbers on two vertical axes of the Indicator as remote from each other as possible. In some positions of the slide the axes A and B’ can be used for this purpose ; in others A, and A’, or B, and B’ must be employed. The horizontal line of the slide being arranged, as just directed, it will be found that at least one of the vertical guide- lines of the slide will intersect the horizontal graduation. By observing now the numbers at which the guide-lines respec- tively stand, the record can be made. Suppose, for example, that the horizontal guide-line ruled upon the slide intersects the verticals of the Indicator at 43, while the right hand ver- tical of the slide cuts the horizontal series of numbers of the Indicator at 75; the entry to be made for this object in the register would be written thus 43’; and whenever that particular object is to be found either by the same Indicator or any other copy of it, if the slide is placed at these numbers, and the In- dicator is properly centred, the object must be in the field of view. In the same manner any number of objects can be re- gistered or found. If the slide happens to be so placed that both of its verticals intersect the graduated portions of the horizontal line C, D, the position of either one of them can be recorded at will. If a guide-line upon the slide falls between two divisions of either scale, the fraction of the division may be estimated with sufficient accuracy by the eye or a hand-magnifier and 251" Bay would mean that the vertical lines of the Indicator were inter- sected at 1-8th of a division of the scale beyond 25, while the vertical guide-line of the slide passed 1-4th of a division beyond the number 34 of the horizontal scale, as nearly as could be estimated. It is convenient to let the lower edge of the glass slide rest against a straight-edged guide-piece, which can be moved parallel to the horizontal line of the Indicator. By pushing the slide along this edge, all the objects on the same horizontal line can be found without changing the position of the guide- piece. By moving the guide-piece a little forwards or back- wards another sweep across the slide may be made, and so on until every object of interest is found. By following the directions above given it will be found that the recording or finding of objects by means of the Indi- cator 1s very easily performed, and scarcely requires the time which has been employed in describing the method. It is entered in the register. Thus the recorded position 58 BAILEY, ON A UNIVERSAL believed that the explanation above given is sufficiently ex- plicit to enable any one to use the Indicator; but some addi- tional remarks will now be made upon the reasons for adopting the particular arrangement I have used, the modes of insuring accuracy in manipulation, and the modifications of which the Indicator is susceptible for individual convenience. It was desired to make the instrument capable of universal application, so simple that it could be adapted to any stage ; so light and yet so strong that it could be sent without injury by mail or otherwise to any distance; and, lastly, that the different copies should be perfect fac-similes of each other and reproducible at any time. All this is secured by having the Indicator engraved upon a steel plate and printed upon cards of uniform quality, and by taking the dimensions from the standard United States inch, preserved in the office of the Superintendent of Weights and Measures in Albany. In order to extend the use of the Indicator to all cases which are likely to occur, the graduation was arranged with reference to slides three inches long and one inch wide, while it will answer equally well for smaller ones. When these slides are not covered with paper, and guide-lines can be ruled as above directed upon the glass itself, the graduations necessary for their use would only extend upon the verticals 4 an inch above and below the horizontal line, and upon the horizontal line only 3 an inch outwards from the points 40 and 70; but in order to provide for paper covered, or opaque slides whose uppermost and lateral edges may be used as guide-lines, the graduation has been extended considerably. It will be found on trial that slides of the standard size, whether paper covered or not, may be employed with the Indicator for the registra- tion of all objects under a glass cover of a square inch in size, which is quite as large as is likely to be used. In using cover- ing glasses of an inch square it will be found necessary to employ the horizontal numbers 0 to 50, and the verticals A, A', for objects towards the right of the cover, and the other axes and numbers for objects towards the left. For a portion of the objects under the cover, either set of axes and numbers may be used at pleasure, provided that the verticals are chosen as far apart as possible. Two verticals on the same side of the centre should never be used together, as a small error in observing the numbers would have more effect in displacing the object from the centre than if two axes at a greater distance had been em- ployed. ‘The reason for leaving a blank ungraduated space between 50 and 60 on the horizontal line was to allow a fac- simile of the Indicator to be engraved upon the stage of any INDICATOR FOR MICROSCOPES. 59 microscope, the blank space being left for the portion of the stage occupied by the aperture. The guide-lines upon the glass may be ruled with a fine- pointed scratching diamond, and be rendered more visible by having graphite or black lead rubbed into them. Lines ruled in this manner will answer for all except very minute objects ; but in consequence of the widening of the lines by the chip- ping up of the glass due to unequal expansions and contrac- tions, the lines often become too wide and irregular for very accurate adjustments. In such cases admirable guide-lines may be etched upon the glass with the vapour of fluohydric acid, and can be made of any required degree of fineness. The solution of the acid should not be employed for the etching, as it gives lines which are too smooth and difficult to see, and which will not retain the black lead if rubbed into them. The power of the objective employed in determining the position of an object for registration, should always be the highest which can be conveniently employed ; while in search- ing for an object already recorded, a power lower than that employed in the registration may be used. The object then must be in the field of view, and would be at the centre but for slight errors in manipulation, or the want of perfect ad- justment in the mountings of the object-glass. Care should be taken to bring each object accurately to the centre of the field of view, before recording it. It will then require an error equal to half the diameter of the field of view to throw it out of that field. For example, the field of view of my 4-inch objective, made by Spencer, includes two divisions of the Indicator, and hence an error of nearly one division might be made in placing a slide upon the Indicator by means of its recorded numbers, and yet the object would be found in the field. It may happen that in transferring a slide from one Indicator to another that the object when brought into sight by means of its recorded co-ordinates will not appear well centred. If this be due to slight differences in determining the centres of the Indicator, and yet the record has been carefully made, it is easy to correct for the difference in the following manner. Move the Indicator with the slide placed at any recorded position until the object comes into the centre of the field of view, then secure the Indicator to the stage in this new posi- tion, and all other objects recorded by the same Indicator ought to be brought to the centre of the field of view by means of the numbers as registered. The convenience of the Indicator for individual use may be 60 BAILEY, ON A UNIVERSAL increased by several slight changes.’ One of these consists in removing the paper centre-piece, and replacing it either tem- porarily or permanently by a glass plate bearing lines at right angles to each other ruled very lightly with a diamond point, and so adjusted as to coincide with the prolongation of C D and E F through the centre. For all but the highest powers there is no objection to having these excessively minute lines permanently beneath the centre of the Indicator, as they do not perceptibly interfere with the light, and it is convenient to have them always in place. ‘They can be ruled upon a piece of mica or thin glass cemented to the hack of the Indicator, or the latter may itself be cemented to a piece of plate glass and the central guide-lines then carefully ruled. Even for the highest powers these lines can be used in record- ing the position of objects, which can then be found for study by using an Indicator of the ordinary form. By a proper arrangement, a moveable stage, with screws for vertical and horizontal motions, may be graduated so as to correspond to the Indicator, and yet preserve all the advantages of accurate adjustment which the screws afford. For this purpose it is necessary to observe that if the Indicator be placed upon the stage and accurately centred, with its guide-line, C D, parallel to the front edge of the stage, and a slide be then placed upon the Indicator, so that its horizontal guide-line shall coincide with C D, and the right-hand vertical guide-line stand at 70, (2. e. in the position which would be recorded as 3$’,) or its left- hand guide-line at 3$’; then a motion of the stage itself bearing with it the Indicator and slide, or an equal motion of the slide upon the Indicator and fixed stage, will bring the same point of the slide to the centre of the field of view. Therefore, by attaching to the stage in any convenient manner graduations corresponding to those of the Indicator, and by having lines corresponding to 39’ and £§’ ruled upon the stage, it will only be necessary to place the slide directly on the stage at these numbers, the stage itself being set either at $$' or 4%’ of its graduations. By turning the milled heads of the screws which give the vertical and horizontal motions of the stage, the object can be brought into the field of view, and recorded or found again by means of the numbers attached to the stage; while the record may be used for any other Indicator as if made in the usual manner. If the distance between the guide-lines upon the slide agrees accurately with that between 40 and 70 of the Indicator, the slide, when placed upon the moveable stage at either 59%’ or $9’, will need no displacement for the whole series of numbers; but if this distance do not agree, the slide must be put with its left- INDICATOR FOR MICROSCOPES. 61 hand vertical coinciding with the left-hand vertical of the stage for all numbers from 0 to 50 of the horizontal series ; while from 60 to 110 of the same series the slide must be set so that its right-hand vertical coincides with the right-hand vertical of the stage; in each case the horizontal lines of the stage and slide being adjusted to coincide. By observing this rule the necessity of perfect accuracy in the position of the guide-lines upon the slides is done away with. There are some objections, but not insuperable ones, to the moveable stage Indicator as above described. In the first place, the stage as usually made has its motion too limited to correspond to the whole range of the Indicator; and secondly, the guide-lines ruled upon the stage for one object-glass may not answer for other powers on account of slight inaccuracies of mounting. The stages can doubtless be constructed to give as wide a range for motion as required, which will do away with the first-mentioned objection. ‘The second may be removed by placing an Indicator upon the upper plate of the stage when the latter stands at 3°’, and adjusting it so that when well centred for the power employed the line C F shall be parallel to the front edge of the stage. The slide being then placed upon the Indicator, with its guide-lines at 39’ or $8’, the re- maining motions may be made with the screws in the usual manner, and the numbers may be read off from the stage-scales instead of the Indicator. The above-mentioned modifications are excellent for in- dividual convenience; but for the general purposes of science, the comparable, transferable, reproducible Indicator, in its simplest form, must be preserved ; and it is only in that form that it deserves the name, suggested by a friend, of the Uni- versal Indicator. As a proof of the utility and accuracy of the Indicator, and of its convenience as a means of scientific exchange, I may state that numerous mounted slides of minute recent and fossil diatoms have been exchanged through the Post Office by Judge A. S. Johnson of Albany, and myself, and that each has found by the ordinary as well as modified forms of the Indicator all the shells, however minute, fragmentary or previously unknown, which the other had recorded. Some of these objects were less than 1-1000th of an inch in dia- meter, and yet they were found without difficulty by means of the Indicator. To determine whether different impressions of the Indicator when made on the same kind of paper were comparable, a set of objects was registered successively by seven different im- 62 ON A UNIVERSAL INDICATOR FOR MICROSCOPES. pressions made on enamelled cards, some of which were arranged with the ordinary paper centre-piece, and others with the central guide-lines ruled upon glass. The numbers being recorded for the objects when well centred upon one of these Indicators, the slide was then transferred to each of the other Indicators, and each object being brought into the field by its recorded numbers, the position was carefully adjusted so that the object should be well centered, and a record for each copy of the Indicator was thus made. On comparing the different numbers it was found that the coincidence was almost perfect, the difference never exceeding one-fourth of one of the divisions of the Indicator, an amount which might be quadrupled before an object would be thrown out of the field of view of my 34-inch objective. The Indicator having been put to so many and such severe tests, I feel no hesitation in recommending it as a means of scientific intercourse among observers, and as a means by which collections of microscopic objects may be registered, arranged, and catalogued ; and an index to the whole so made that any particular specimen may be found at will either by the original observer or any one into whose hands the slides and accompanying register may at any time come. The copy of the Indicator which accompanies this paper is not given for use with the microscope, as the kind of paper upon which it is printed is different from that used for the standard Indicator, and therefore in consequence of unequal shrinkage a slight deviation is produced. The Indicator for use with the microscope is printed upon enamelled cards, and the different impressions have been found to agree so closely with each other as well as with the original plate that no appreciable error is perceived. I cannot close this paper without expressing my warm thanks to Judge A. S. Johnson, of the New York Court of Appeals, for his cordial sympathy and aid in testing the merits of the Indicator, and for some excellent suggestions as to its best form for general use. I should also express my obligations to the engraver, J. E. Gavit, Esq., of Albany, who has spared no pains in making the steel plate from which the Indicator is printed as accurate as possible. TRANSLATIONS. On the ImprEGNATION and GrrRminaTION of Atex. By M. Prinesuetmm. (Abridged from the Reports of the Berlin Academy.) Tue existence of sexuality in the vegetable kingdom, though at first surmised simply upon a presumed analogy in this respect between animals and plants, and long a disputed point in science, has for some time been admitted as an indisputable fact. In the Phanerogamia especially, the necessity of the conjunction of the pollen tube and the ovule for the produc- tion of the embryo can no longer be denied by any one. Observations and experiments whose results admit of no dis- pute, have established this fact, although opinions may vary as to the essential nature of the act of impregnation, The sexual organs of the higher Cryptogamia also are known ; but with respect to the mode in which the respective organs participate materially in the act of impregnation, and even as regards the necessity of their co-operation, we possess at present ‘little more than vague surmises, In the Floridee, Fucoidee, Lichens, and Fungi, older and more recent researches have, at most, merely indicated the existence of organs to which sexual functions may possibly be assigned. The latest endeavours, lastly, to demonstrate the existence of antheridia in the fresh-water Alge, with the exception of certain fortunate indications, to which I shall return, may be said to have wholly failed. This condition, however, of our knowledge, with respect to the sexuality of plants, cannot be regarded as very encou- raging. For, admitting that, in order to prove the existence of sexuality it is not sufficient to show the presence of dif- ferent organs, to which sexual functions may by possibility belong, but also to demonstrate the co-operation of these organs in the formation of the seed or of the young plant ; it is obvious that the sexuality of plants, even in that division of the vegetable kingdom in which the organs to which the sexual function has been assigned are already known, has not been demonstrated with that degree of certainty which admits of no doubts being entertained. The grounds upon which the existence of sexual relations in the Cryptogamia, has been assumed, properly reside only in the analogy between 64 PRINGSHEIM, ON THE IMPREGNATION the bodies contained in the antheridia and the spermatic filaments in animals; and again, in a few isolated observa- tions on the sterility of female Mosses and Rhizocarpee in the absence of the male plants or organs; and lastly, in the occurrence of hybrid forms among Ferns. All these phe- nomena, allow the true nature of the antheridia to be assumed with great probability, but they are insufficient to afford a scientific proof of it. What has been wanting for a clear and convincing proof is the demonstration of at least a single instance, in which the entrance of the vegetable spermatozoids into the female organ, and their influence thereupon may be seen with perfect dis- tinctness and in a way readily at the command of any observer. This requirement, however, is not fulfilled by our observations with respect to the process in the sexual organs in either the higher or the lower cryptogams. I do not deny the value of Thuret’s researches, which show, in the way of experiment, the sexuality of the Fucacee; but in morphological processes, direct visual observation of the process is necessarily of greater value than experiments which always leave room for some degree of doubt. Besides this, Thuret has merely stated the results of his experiments, and has not communicated the precise conditions under which they were instituted. Experimental researches of this kind, may, it is true, show the necessary existence of two kinds of organs for the formation of the young plant, but they throw no light upon the essential nature of the act of fertilization. I am equally disposed to recognize the value of Suminski’s statements, who says that he has witnessed the entrance of the spermatozoids into the archegonium of Ferns, in Pteris serrulata ; as well as the importance of Hofmeister’s obser- vation, who has noticed the same thing in Aspidium filix mas. But in both these instances the tissue surrounding the archegonium opposes such difficulties to precise observation, and the phenomenon is so little under the control of the inquirer, that the witnessing of this occurrence can only be regarded as a rare piece of good fortune in an individual observer. Such instances are, certainly, wholly unfitted to constitute the basis of a general scientific conviction; leaving altogether out of question, the circumstance that Suminski’s observations have received much contradiction, and that, in any case, he has been deceived as to the part played by the spermatic filaments in the archegonium. It must, therefore, be regarded as a particularly fortunate circumstance, that I have succeeded in witnessing the process in a plant, in which it was possible to observe the penetration AND GERMINATION OF ALG. 65 of the spermatozoids into the female organ, with the utmost distinctness and clearness, even into the minutest details of the proczeding ; in a plant, in fact, so happily organized that the fertilizing organs may be directly observed without injury to it in its natural condition; and in which, lastly, the female organ, owing to its transparency, offers such a slight obstacle to observation that the motion of the spermatozoids, within it, may be closely watched for hours togcther, so long as it lasts. I have noticed the gradual completion of both sexual organs so far, as to be enabled to describe the con- ditions presented in them, which immediately precede the commencement of the act of impregnation. These circum- stances place the phenomenon so much under the control of the observer, that he is able previously to determine the time of the commencement of the phenomenon, and in a condition readily to demonstrate the whole act of impregnation before others. Lastly, since I have made these observations in Vaucheria sessilis, one of the lowest of the fresh-water Alga, it would appear that the process of impregnation is at present more precisely known in one of the lowest divisions of the vegetable kingdom, than it is in any of the other higher plants, or in any animal; nor does it, furthermore, scarcely admit of doubt, that sex is a universal property of all organisms, manifesting a wonderful analogy in the most highly organized animals, as well as in the simplest cellular plants. 1. The Vaucheria, besides the asexual multiplication by zoospores, also exhibits a true sexual propagation, effected by means of the two organs, known as the hornlets (Hérnchen) and spores. Even Vaucher, who first noticed these organs, entertained a suspicion with respect to the nature of the “ hornlets,” which he declared to be the anthers of the plant, stating that the fertilizing pollen, which, as he thought, filled the entire tube, was discharged through them. With his means of observation he could scarcely have penetrated more deeply into the nature of the process, and it is highly to his credit that he should have advanced so far towards an expla- nation of it. This view of Vaucher’s with respect to the true nature of the “ hornlets,” is far nearer the truth than are the assertions of later algologists of the occurrence of a copulation of the *‘ hornlet,” and the contiguous spore, an assertion which is at once contradicted by attentive consideration of the relative positions of the mouth of the spore and of the “ hornlet” before and after impregnation. ‘lhe notion arose from a sup- posed analogy between the phenomena of fructification in the Vaucherte and the formation of the spores in the Spirogyre. VOL. Iv. F 66 PRINGSHEIM, ON THE IMPREGNATION This opinion, however, as well as Karsten’s recent unfor- tunate exposition of the processes said to take place in the ‘‘ hornlets” and spore-fruit of Vaneheria will be found to be untenable from the following description of the act of fruc- tification in that plant. But the true process of impregnation in Vaucheria and the development of both kinds of sexual organs—the “ hornlet” and the contiguous stunted organ, which is more correctly termed “ spore-fruit,” [sporangium| than “ spore,” takes place in the following manner. Both organs arise like papillary branches from the tube, and in close proximity; and it is usually the case that the papilla destined to become the ** hornlet,” is formed sooner than that in which the spore ori- ginates (Plate III. fig. 1). The two papille even from the first differ so widely in dimensions, that they can scarcely be con- founded. The papilla which becomes the “ hornlet,” soon elongates into a short, cylindrical, slender branch, which, at first, rises perpendicularly from the tube, then curves down- wards until it comes in contact with the tube, often forming a second or a third curve, and in this way always represents a more or less stunted branch which frequently exhibits several spiral turns. The papilla of the neighbouring “sporangium,” usually begins to appear at the time when the “ hornlet” is commencing its first turn; but the period at which it arises is very indeterminate, for it sometimes appears much earlier whilst the “ hornlet” is still perfectly straight, sometimes much later after it has curved, soas to form two limbs of equal length. The papilla destined to become the sporangium, gradually enlarges into a considerable sized, lateral out-growth of the tube, far exceeding the hornlet in width, whilst in length it is barely equal to the straight limb of the latter (fig. 2). This out-growth, which is at first symmetrical, ultimately throws out a beak-like prolongation on the side looking towards the horn- let,—the “ rostrate appendage,” (rostrum) of the sporangium, whence the latter acquires its peculiar form, resembling that of a half-developed vegetable ovule (fig. 3). Up to this period the hornlet as well as the sporangium are not shut off from the tube from which they spring by any septum; the cavity of the hornlet and that of the sporangium consequently remain uninterruptedly continuous with the parent tube, and are filled with similar contents. A great number of elongated chlorophyll granules lodged in an albuminous plasma—never, in this case, starch—and rounded, larger or smaller oil globules, constitute a dense, internal lining in the tube, the sporangium, and the hornlet. Between this granular, parietal investment AND GERMINATION OF ALG. 67 and the true thick cellulose membrane, is a very thin layer of colourless substance which I have elsewhere described as the ‘* cutaneous layer” (Hautschicht) of the cell-contents.* The sporangium is also especially characterized by the circum- stance that a considerable number of oil-drops accumulate in it and apparently occupy the whole of its proper cavity. At this stage of development, a septum is suddenly formed at the base of the sporangium, which is henceforth an inde- pendent cell, completely separated from the parent tube (fig. 4). Even before the sporangixm has become separated from the parent tube by the septum, there may be noticed in the rostrate elongation directed towards the ‘ hornlet,” the gradual accumulation of a colourless fine granular substance, of the same nature as that with which the wall of the parent tube and of the sporangium is lined on the inner surface, and which, as I have already stated, has been termed by me the cutaneous layer. This accumulation of the ‘ cutaneous layer” in the fore part of the rostrate process is continued after the formation of the septum between the sporangium and tube, and in consequence of its continued increase the remaining con- tents of the sporangium, the oil-drops, chlorophyll, and plasma are by degrees pushed towards the back and base of the sporangium (fig. 4). Whilst these phenomena are being ma- nifested in the sporangium, the ‘“ hornlet’” also undergoes very remarkable changes. In its apex, which, so long as the hornlet continues to grow, presents the same conditions as the summits of the growing branches of Vaucheria, the contents, owing to the disappearance of the chlorophyll, have become almost completely colourless, except that occasionally a few chloro- phyll granules remain; sometimes more sometimes less. Thus the point of the “hornlet,”’ like that of the sporangium, appears at this time to be filled with a colourless substance, but which is mot constituted by an accumulation of the ‘“‘ cutaneous layer” at this point, but manifestly arises from a molecular change associated with an alteration of form and colour in the contents previously existing at the apex. ‘This difference in the mode of formation of the colourless substance, occupying the apices of the horn and of the sporangium, should be carefully borne in mind; it is very essentially con- nected with the different morphological destination of the two substances. So soon as the contents of the point of the ‘‘ hornlet’’ have become colourless in the mode just described, they appear to be constituted of a very fine-grained granulose * A notice of the Author’s ‘ Researches on the Structure and Formation of the Vegetable Cell,’ will appear in the next Number of the ‘ Quarterly Journal of Microscopical Science.’ F 2 68 PRINGSHEIM, ON THE IMPREGNATION mucous substance, of whose constitution, however, no clear insight can be obtained. Now, so soon as the transformation of the contents has taken place, the apex of the hornlet, so far as it is colourless, is suddenly parted from the lower, green portion by a septum, and is thus transformed into an independent cell, having no communication with the parent tube, and the basal part of the hornlet. In this case the septum is not formed as in the sporangium, at the base of the process, but in the middle. But the point at which the septum is formed, in the “ hornlet,” is not very determinate ; the portion thus cut off from the rest being sometimes larger sometimes smaller. After the formation of the septum in the ‘“ hornlet,” the colourless mucus in its apex gradually assumes a more deter- minate form, and at this time a large number of minute, perfectly colourless, rod-like bodies may be readily perceived crowded together irregularly, and which being still here and there surrounded by the amorphous mucus are, as it were, imbedded in it. Close observation also will disclose an in- distinct movement exhibited even thus early by some of the little rods, and from which their destination may be anticipated. This perfecting of the ‘ hornlet” coincides in time with that stage of development of the sporangium, at which the accumulation of the “‘ cutaneous layer” in the anterior part of the rostrate process has attained to its greatest extent ; and this condition of the sporangium and of the hornlet immediately precedes the act of impregnation. This is effected in the following manner: the pressure within the sporangium upon its walls, and especially in the direction of the rostrum, becomes greater and greater in con- sequence of the continued increase of the “‘ cutaneous layer” in the forepart of the rostrum, until ultimately the membrane is ruptured exactly at the point of the rostrum, and allows a portion of the ‘‘ cutaneous layer” to escape (fig. 6). ‘The de- tachment of the extruded portion is attended with all the appearances which accompany the slow separation of a mucous substance into two portions, and which in the present case show in the clearest manner the non-existence of any mem- brane around the escaped portion of contents. This portion then assumes the character of a drop of mucus, which remains lying near the opening of the sporangium, and without under- going any organization perishes, after exhibiting the various phenomena due to the absorption of water and disintegration (figs. 7 and 8). The accumulation of the “ cutaneous layer ” in the interior of the sporangium, in the anterior part of the AND GERMINATION OF ALG. 69 rostrum, and the escape of a portion of it, are merely the mechanism by which the opening is produced in the sporan- gium destined for the admission of the spermatozoids. Im- mediately after the formation of the opening in the sporangium, and in remarkable coincidence with the escape of the “ cuta- neous layer” through the rostrum, the “ hornlet” opens at the apex and pours out its contents (fig. 5). Innumerable, exces- sively minute, rod-like corpuscles, most of them already nearly isolated, though many at the moment of the opening of the * hornlet” still imbedded in the mucus, escape at once though the orifice. Those already isolated exhibit an extraordinarily rapid movement in all directions, and those imbedded in the mucus do not become detached tiil after- wards, when they follow the others with equal rapidity. The field of view is soon covered with mobile corpuscles. In great number (20, 30, or more) they enter the neighbouring orifice of the sporangium, which they fill almost entirely (fig. 9), penetrating through the portion of the cutaneous layer re- maining in the sporangium, which, though obviously without any definite membranous boundary, owing to its viscous, mucous consistence, offers a solid resistance to their further penetration into the sporangium. The corpuscles continue thus to struggle forwards into the “cutaneous layer” for more than half an hour; bounding against its outer surface they retreat, again push forwards, again retreat, and so on in an uninterrupted succession of assaults and retreats— wonderful spectacle for the observer! After this commotion has lasted some time an abrupt boundary-line suddenly ap- pears in the outer aspect of the “ cutaneous layer’’ (fig. 10), the first indication of a tunic forming around the contents of the sporangium, which were before bare. From this moment the mobile corpuscles are separated from the “ cutaneous layer” by a membrane which effectually prevents their further action upon the contents. They continue, it is true, to move, to and fro, and in the roseate process, and this motion often lasts for hours together, but at last they perish in the rostrum itself, their motion becoming gradually slower and slower and finally ceasing. Even after the lapse of several hours, and when the act of impregnation has long been performed, the quiescent, dead corpuscles may be seen in the rostrum, lying on the front of the spore in the interior of the sporangium, until at last they are completely dissolved and all vestige of them disappears. The portion of the “cutaneous layer,” re- maining in front of the green contents of the sporangium, constitutes a thick stratum of a colourless and transparent substance immediately within the orifice in the sporangium, 70 PRINGSHEIM, ON THE IMPREGNATION and consequently the penetration of the mobile corpuscles, the spermatozoids of the Vaucheria, into the opening, and their continued efforts, as it were, to force themselves into the ‘* cutaneous layer,” may be observed with the utmost distinct- ness and precision. In several instances also, after the sper- matozoids had already been for some time within the sporan- gium, I have very distinctly noticed the sudden appearance of a larger, colourless corpuscle at the extreme border of, but yet within, the cutaneous layer (fig. 10), and of which previously not a vestige was perceptible. Its sudden appearance after the impregnation, its superficial position in the ‘‘ cutaneous layer,” its consistence and aspect, allow scarcely any doubt to be entertained that this corpuscle arises from one of the sper- matozoids. I shall subsequently describe a nearly similar thing attending the act of impregnation in the Fucacee, and will here merely advert to the remarkable circumstance that the act of impregnation does not take place between a per- fectly-formed cell and one or more spermatozoids ; but that the action of the spermatozoids is exerted upon the, as yet, unorganized contents of the sporangium, which do not become a cell surrounded with a membrane until after the act of im- pregnation has taken place—the true embryonic cell of the plant. With respect to the structure of the spermatozoids of Vau- cheria, I shall here merely remark that when in the mobile condition they present the appearance of elongated slender rods about 1-180’” in size; when killed by means of iodine, whilst in this state, | have never been able to perceive any further structure in them. Whilst those spermatozoids which have ultimately ceased to move after long-continued strug- gling, but without having entered the opening of the sporan- gium, appear, very distinctly, like minute clear vesicles, also about 1-180’” in size, exhibit a distinct opaque, not brown point, and, as I have seen with the utmost clearness, two cilia of unequal length. Their movement is obviously more like that of the corpuscles of which the contents of the antheridia in Fucus are composed, than that of zoospores. I have stated that the portion of the cutaneous layer left in the sporangium after its bursting, and after the entrance of the spermatozoids, together with the remaining contents of the sporangium, are surrounded with a membrane, and become a cell which completely fills the sporangium—the embryonic cell of the plant. The formation of this membrane of the embryonic cell of Vaucheria is one of the most convincing instances in favour of my views respecting the origin of the cell-wall, in an im- AND GERMINATION OF ALG/E. 71 mediate transformation of the “cutaneous layer” (of the so-termed “ primordial utricle”). The separation of a por- tion of the “ cutaneous layer,” as above described, renders it certain that, at the time when the rostrum of the sporangium is ruptured, the contents of the latter are not surrounded by any proper membrane: but it is also obvious that the cutaneous layer, which after the escape of a portion of it through the opening still surrounds the green contents of the sporangium, and is accumulated in a particularly thick stratum over that part of the contents which correspond with the opening, diminishes considerably in thickness when the formation of the membrane ensuing upon the impregnation takes place ; and this diminution in thickness goes on in proportion as the membrane in question ¢ncreases in thickness (figs. 10, 11, 12, 13). In this case the transformation of the cutaneous layer into the membrane may almost be witnessed. This membrane gradually increases to a considerable thickness; at a later period it appears to be formed of numerous thin lamine, and it applies itself to all parts of the open tunic of the sporan- gium (fig. 14). After the completion of the coat of the true spore, scarcely a trace of the previously well-developed cuta- neous layer remains ; an excessively thin parietal lining con- stituted of it alone remaining. The green contents, which had been forced back by the accumulation of the cutaneous layer, in the mean while again spread themselves uniformly throughout the perfect spore, and form as in all cells a thick, internal parietal coating. The true spore thus formed by the impregnation represents, consequently, a large cell occupying the whole of the sporan- gium, whose membrane, formed probably in consequence of and certainly after the impregnation, appears to be laminated. It is surrounded on all sides by the persistent tunic of the sporangium, which is open in front and prolonged into the rostrum. In this condition the spore remains for some time longer, without being thrown off from the parent tube on which it was produced: but the colour of its contents, which was at first green, gradually becomes paler and paler; the spore is at last rendered quite colourless, and presents in its interior only one or more largish dark-brown bodies (fig. 14, 16). When it has lost all its colour it is detached from the parent tube, in consequence of the decay of the membrane of the sporangium enclosing it (fig. 17). After some time (in my experiments, after about three months) the spore, which is readily recognizable by the red-brown nucle? in its interior, suddenly resumes its green colour (fig. 18), and immediately 72 MULLER, ON SPHZROZOUM thereupon grows into a young Vaucheria, exactly resembling the parent plant (fig. 19, 20). Close observation shows that the innermost layer, elongating, breaks through the thick outer membrane, and becomes the young tube, exactly in the same way as I have described the process of development in the germinating spore of Spirogyra. The observation of the germination of this spore, however, completes the proof that the cell produced in consequence of the action of the spermatozoids is the true propagative cell of Vaucheria arising from a sexual act. (To be continued.) On Spu#rozoum, Meyen. (Tuatassicotta, Huxley.) Nocri- Luca, and the Potycystinz. By Prof. Miter. (‘ Report of Berlin Academy, April 19, 1855.) In the ‘Annals of Nat. Hist.,’ 2 ser., vol. 8, p. 433, Mr. Huxley describes what he regarded as a new genus of zoophytes, under the name of Thalassicolla. This produc- tion, whether animal or vegetable, is found in transparent, colourless, gelatinous masses of very various forms and size ; showing no evidence of contractility nor any power of loco- motion. Of such bodies Mr, Huxley notices two very distinct kinds—the one, consisting of oval or constricted, and many spherical masses, is distinguished to the naked eye by pos- sessing numerous darker dots scattered about in its substance ; whilst the other is always spherical, has no dots, but presents a very dark, blackish centre, the periphery being more or less clear. For the former kind Mr. Huxley adopted the provisional name of JZ. punctata, and for the latter that of J. nucleata, but without prejudging the question as to the existence of specific distinctions. These creatures, which are described as consisting funda- mentally of a mass of cells united by jelly, “ like an animal Palmella,” are placed by Mr, Huxley with the Protozoa, and regarded by him as belonging to the same great division as the Sponges, Foraminifera, Infusorie, and Gregarinida,— unicellular animals. Of the two species, J. punctata and T. nucleata, the former appears to present several varieties, and the latter seems to approach very closely in its nature to Noctiluca. In the Reports of the Berlin Academy for April 19, 1855, is a paper by Prof. Miiller upon Spherozoum and Thalassi- AND THALASSICOLLA. 13 colla. The former name was applied, in 1834, by Meyen to a form of agastric animal, which he descrihes as a spherical, muco-gelatinous mass, constituted internally of globules, which again consist of vesicles. This genus, although Meyen’s description is not quite accurate, would clearly appear from his figure, according to Prof. Miiller, to be identical with the Thalassicolla of Huxley. Prof. Miiller then proceeds to describe and discuss the structure and varieties of the different forms assembled by common characters under this generic group, and fully con- firms in every particular the description given by Mr. Huxley. But he is disposed to subdivide the Thalassicolla of that observer into two sub-genera, and adds an account of other specific forms. One subdivision of the group, for which he would retain the term Spherozoum, Meyen, on account of its priority, would include Spherozoum (Thalassicolla) fuscum, Meyen, and §. ( 7.) punctata, Huxley, and a minute descrip- tion of their structure is given. A second form, noticed by Mr. Huxley as a variety of T. punctata, and characterized by its containing in the centre a prismatic crystal, or crystals, and having a fenestrated shell not unlike that of a Polycystina, Ehr., he erects into the type of a distinct genus or sub-genus with the name of Collo- sphera, assigning to it the specific designation of C. Huzley?. In his description of the structure, which corresponds fully with that of Mr. Huxley, he lays particular stress upon the nature of the crystals contained in the large cells. These are sometimes present in small, sometimes in considerable num- ber, and in one case he counted twenty-seven in a single cell. They are about 1-60" in length, clear and colourless, and from their form, together with their insolubility, of a nature altogether unusual in organized bodies. ‘They are rhombic prisms, belonging to the two-and-two-membered system, with four-sided summits and a greater or less truncation of the acute, long angle of the prism. Upon measurement of the angles, which from the size of the crystals was not very easily taken, it appeared that the crystalline form agreed in a very remarkable manner with that of the sulphates of strontian and of barytes. Their chemical properties, also, which are described, would indicate that they were composed of a difficultly soluble earthy sulphate, which, however, could not be that of lime. And although strontian and barytes have not been observed in sea-water, the presence of the latter earth therein may be surmised from the circumstance that celestine is met with in the fossiliferous marine deposits, in the muschelkalk, lias, cretaceous and tertiary formations, 74 MULLER, ON SPHZROZOUM The author then discusses the question of the relationship of the Collosphera with Ehrenberg’s Polycystina, with the shells of which that of the former exhibits a striking resem- blance, and especially with that of Cenosphera Plutonis, Ebr. Mr. Huxley’s second species, 7. nucleata, he conceives, requires much consideration before its true place can be assigned. But for the present he regards it as advisable to separate T. nucleata with the Physematia of Meyen from the gelatinous bodies with silicious skeletons, and leave the question of their true nature open. With reference, how- ever, to the points of analogy indicated by Huxley between his 7. nucleata and Noctiluca, especially in the fact of the motion of the granules in the interior, Prof. Miiller takes the opportunity of noticing certain luminous bodies having the appearance of an encysted Noctiluca miliaris. “These encysted bodies,” he says, ‘‘ constituted the principal luminous animalcules observed at Messina in the autumn of 1853.” Free Noctiluce, at that season were not seen there; and in 1849 the same kind of encysted bodies were very common at Nice. The cyst is a perfectly transparent, spherical capsule, with a light-bluish brilliancy at the edge, and appearing like the egg-membrane of some crustacea. Within this cyst is lodged a body in all respects resembling the LNoctiluca miliaris, except that at this time no vibratile filament can be perceived. The Noctiluca-like creature fills the cyst more or less entirely, though occasionally it is much smaller. In this condition the animalcules are luminous without being agitated. When the cysts are examined under the microscope in a small quantity of sea-water, in such a way that during the observation the saline contents are notably increased in conse- quence of the evaporation, a moment speedily arrives when the Noctiluca-like body suddenly contracts itself within its case into a little nodule, that is to say, it contracts upon the yellowish, granular nucleus from which the filamentary strings of the interior proceed. I have noticed this vital phenomenon, not on one occasion only, but in many of the encysted animal- cules.” “ The size of the case is usually from 1-5 to 1-4". But many are far smaller, even down to 1-10". Occasionally, also, instead of a Noctiluca, cysts may be observed, containing a yellow nucleus 1-24" in diameter, and once I noticed a cyst 2-10" in size, containing, besides this rounded yellow nucleus, quite isolated, an extremely minute Noctiluca-like body. Of the free Noctiluce taken near Heligoland in the autumn, the smallest were 1-20" and the larger 4-20"—7-20" in diameter. ‘The common variety of form, with a constriction AND THALASSICOLLA. 75 of the circumference, which is noticed in free NWoctiluce, and the radiating filamentary branching striae beset with extremely minute granules in the interior, were also characteristic of the encysted bodies, which J should be the more indisposed to separate from the WNoctiluce, from their possessing the most remarkable luminous power. At present we want the key to these remarkable phenomena, as well as all knowledge of the development and course of life of the Noctiluce. After discussing the probable relations of Thalassicolla with the Sponges and Polycystina—but without coming to any positive conclusion on the subject, except, that in any case the two forms of Thalassicolla and Collosphera must go together— Prof. Miiller proceeds to describe a new genus, apparently closely allied to them, under the name of Acanthometra, Miiller. It consists of solitary, pelagic, silicious organisms, with a gelatinous envelope to the body. ‘They are motionless micro- scopic creatures, constructed of a radiating silicious frame- work, the long, usually polyhedral crystals of which are disposed symmetrically in all directions, and meet in the centre without forming any central cavity. ‘The needles are disposed in several decussating planes, and meet in the centre with their conical truncated extremities. This construction of the centre out of the conical ends of rays is observed in an otherwise widely different structure insoluble in acid, which Professor Miiller has described and figured, from the intes- tinal contents of the Comatula mediterranea, and which has been termed by Ehrenberg Asterolampra pelagica. The Acanthometre differ from the Thalassicolle in the junction of their spicules in the middle, and in the circum- stance that they are solitary, and, so far, are a distinct formation. Like the Polycystine they do not constitute masses, but are distinguished from them by the absence of a fenestrated shell, as well as by the construction of their silicious skeleton. Actiniscus and Bacteriastrium differ from Acanthometra in the circumstance that their rays lie in a single plane and are united to a common centre. Of the Polycystine, Professor Miller remarks, that species of Haliomma, Dictyospyris, Encyrtidium, Podocyrtis are occa- sionally brought to the surface of the sea by currents and other movements of the water; at any rate it is certain, that, though very rarely, they may occasionally be taken in the drawing of a fine net, on larve of Echinoderms, fully-formed young Echinoderms, Meduse, Crustacea, Pteropoda, \arve of Gasteropods, Conchifera, Annelids, &c., and on Infusoria ; and the living Polycystine taken by him have been thus picked up on pelagic objects. In the same way also an 76 QUATREFAGES, ON THE abundance of organic bodies are procured, which have been detached from their proper seat by the action of the sea, such as living arborescent Vorticelle of the genus Carchesium, and Polypes. But heavier minute bodies, as the shells of dead Polythalamia are occasionally brought up from the bottom of the sea. With respect to living Polycystine, he remarks that they are not enclosed in a connected jelly, but that he has seen excessively delicate transparent, distinct filaments, without branches, or joints protruded from the fenestrated shell. These filaments are soft but straight, and it appears as if each filament proceeded from one of the openings in the shell. They resembled the radiating filaments of the jelly in Acanthometra, and of certain infusoria, as Actinophrys, but they were motionless. Within, the shell was always more or less completely filled with a soft, dark-coloured, usually brown substance, which had previously been observed by Ehrenberg in Haliomma. In the Encyrtidium of Messina the substance occupies the interior of the upper part of the shell, or the vault, and is very regularly divided into four lobes, containing’a few clear, round corpuscles. In Dicty- ospyris, when crushed, there are seen in the interior of the shells, cells with: yellowish granular contents. In a form, probably belonging to Haliomma or allied to it, having six spicules disposed in two planes crossing each other at right angles, the slimy matter in the interior of the shell contained both cells with yellowish granular contents 1-240" in size, as well as colourless cells and violet-coloured molecular corpuscles, On the DeEvELopMENT of the SperMaTozoips in TorrEA viTrREA. By M.A. pE Quarreraces. (‘ Ann. d. Sc. Nat.’ 4me Sér. Tom. ii, p. 152.) In a memoir on the organs of sense in the Annelids (Ann. d. Sc. Nat., de Série, t. xiii), I designated, under the name of Torrea vitrea, a worm remarkable for the complex nature and the development of the eyes, and the extreme transparency of the tissues. Owing to this favourable circumstance, as well as to the unusual size of the spermatogenous masses, I was enabled at once to observe in it phenomena, of which I have spoken in a note annexed to the report of Milne Edwards on the results of his travels in Sicily (Ann. d. Sc. Nat., 3e Série, t. ii.), and concerning which J shall now enter more into detail. The spermatogenous masses floating in the fluid contained in the general cavity of this Annelid are irregularly ovoid, SPERMATOZOIDS IN TORREA VITREA. 77 and present themselves, as is usual, in different degrees of development. At first they are perfectly diaphanous, smooth, and manifestly homogeneous, without any trace of an enve- loping membrane. The dimensions attained to by them in this condition reach to as much as 1-16th of a millimeter in length, and 1-23rd of a millimeter in breadth. At this epoch they may be seen to exhibit two grooves, crossing each other at a right angle, and whose direction has not appeared to me to present any constant relation with the form of the mass itself. It is probable that this first form of division may in some sort be accidental, for I have only very rarely noticed it. The number of grooves soon increases, and they become more marked and deeper, and the mass, after having presented a surface subdivided into large irregular lobes, assumes a mul- berry-like aspect, and ultimately becomes completely granu- lous. During the time that these phenomena are being manifested, the mass continues to increase in volume, and in its ultimate condition it is sometimes 1-12th of a millimeter long by nearly 1-16th of a millimeter broad. The masses when a little further advanced soon split up, and the tail of the spermatozoids is then apparent. The spermatozoids continue to adhere to each other for some time longer by their bodies, as well as to the granulations not yet transformed ; ultimately they are gradually separated. At the moment when the spermatozoids separate themselves from the minute masses, of which they constitute a part, their body is almost fusiform, and perhaps not more than 1-100th millim, long, and 1-300th millim. thick. But they grow during the time they remain in the midst of the fluid which bathes them, the body and the tail elongate ; and besides this the former increases considerably in its transverse dia- meter. Among spermatozoids quite mature, some will have attained to a length of 1-60th millim., and breadth of 1-150th millim, I have long since remarked the analogy presented between the progressive breaking up of the spermatogenous masses and that of the vitellus. Numerous observers, it is well known, have confirmed what I have written on this subject since 1845, but it is a point upon which I have found myself continually at discord with some who have been specially engaged in re- searches of this nature. In Germany, more especially, almost every naturalist who has spoken of the development of the spermatozoids has applied, in this department of physiology, the cell-theory of Schwan. The spermatogenous masses, in their eyes, have 78 HARTIG, ON DILUTE SULPHURIC ACID ON represented the mother-cells, whilst the divisions of this mass have been secondary, tertiary, &c., cells. Lastly, the sperma- tozoids themselves have simply been the last generation of cells, separating themselves almost in the manner of vegetable spores. When I made my observations on the Torrea, 1 sought with the greatest care to discover whether there were any envelope around the masses destined to be resolved into sper- matozoids, and notwithstanding their unusual size in this worm I have never been able to perceive the least trace of such a covering. Neither have I been able to distinguish the walls of cells during the division. Since that time I have, many times, instituted researches of the same kind, and invariably with the same result. The spermatogenous masses have always appeared to me to be composed of a perfectly homo- geneous substance, and never to present any indication of a cell-nature. If to these observations are joined the positive facts which I have pointed out in the vitel/us of worms and of the mollusca, the negative results which I have just recorded acquire, as it seems to me, a real value. Thus the cell-theory had been applied, very happily as it seemed, to the segmentation or division of the witellus; but this doctrine necessarily suc- cumbed before the fact that the most marked lobes, those in which both the nucleus and the cell could not fail to have been the best characterized, spontaneously fuse into one another. If, then, theoretical conceptions are discarded in favour of observation, the views which I have just explained will I hope be adopted ; and it will be acknowledged that in this case at least the cell-theory should be abandoned. On the Influence of Dituts Sutpuuric Acrp on the DEprositT Layers of the CELi-watt in its earliest condition. By Dr. T. Hartic. (Botan, Zeitung, March 30, 1855, p. 222.) In a previous paper in the same journal the author has shown that the continued multiplication of cells in the ligneous and alburnum layers, is effected by a twin pair of parent-cells belonging to each fibrous ray, the inner one of which throws off a series of sterile secondary cells towards the medulla, and the outer a similar series towards the bark. Each of the parent-cells, which correspond in size, form, and structure, consists of a thin cell-wall and a double ptychode-sac; the cell-wall itself consists of an internal and of an external cell-membrane, between which is deposited a THE DEPOSIT LAYERS OF THE CELL-WALL. 79 greater or less number of astathe layers, which swell up strongly in sulphuric acid. (Bot. Zeit. 1854, p. 51, Tab. 1, fig. 16-17, a, 0). The youngest of the secondary cells, both of the wood and of the alburnum, exhibit no difference; they correspond in size, form, and structure not only with each other, but also with the two parent-cells, with which they constitute the compound layer designated the ‘cambium.’ The first appa- rent distinction in the structure of the secondary cells destined for the ligneous substance, and of those belonging to the alburnum, is shown in the dotting—the dots in the former being always distinct, and in the latter always grouped in a cribriform fashion. (Bot. Zeit. 1854, Tab. 1, fig. 24). In the part of the ray belonging to the ligneous substance it is the cell-fibres and lamellar-fibres, and in that belonging to the alburnum substance it is the telial-fibres which retain unaltered the cambial condition of their walls; no further thickening of the wall ever takes place in these cells. In the ligneous part of the ray it is the woody fibres, and in that part which belongs to the alburnum it is the true alburnum-fibres which exhibit a further thickening of the cell-wall, which is effected by the deposition of new layers on the inner side of the cambial-wall. These layers of the second and subsequent generations afterwards constitute by far the main part of the thickness of the wall, whilst the cambial-wall contracts to such an extent, that its original constitution of cell-membranes and deposit-layers, which in the course of its development was distinctly demonstrable, is no longer perceptible. In this con- dition I have myself, he says, several times confounded the cambial-wall with what, in other situations, I have correctly described as ‘ eustathe’ (intercellular substance, but not in the sense in which Mohl understands that term), or as ‘ cell-glue.’ Thus, for instance, in my Leben d. Pflanzenzelle, t. ii, fig. 27 e, it is not ‘eustathe,’ but the cambial-wall, contracted by sulphuric acid and no longer capable of expansion, that is re- presented. In a former memoir ‘‘ Upon the formation of the deposit layers,” I have shown how these additional layers arise from the regeneration of the ptychode-sac. The additional layers of the second and subsequent genera- tions, both in the ligneous and in the alburnum fibres, in their youngest condition, assume a beautiful rose-red colour when brought into contact for some hours with dilute sulphuric acid. In the same section and under precisely similar influ- ence of the acid the cambial-wall remains unchanged, both in the region of the ligneous and of the alburnum-fibres, as well 80 WEDDEL, ON THE CYSTOLITES as in the cambium and in the telienchyma, where no part of the wall at any age is coloured by sulphuric acid, owing to the circumstance that the entire cell-wall in these situations is composed of the cambial substance. It may thence be jusily concluded that an original chemical difference exists between the deposit-layers of the cambial wall and the additional layers of the second and subsequent generations ; and that this dif- ference is manifested at a later period in the resistance offered by this parietal layer to the expansive influence of acids and alkalies, The period is but very brief, during which the additional layers of the second and subsequent generations are reddened by sulphuric acid. Ina shoot of Pinus austriaca examined on the 7th June, in which the annual ring had begun to be formed in the early part of May, only the 16-18 outermost fibres of each ray were reddened, whilst the older, 18-20 fibres assumed a brown colour. This gives a period of 2 or 3 weeks as the time during which the reddening effect of sulphuric acid is manifested. On the Cystouites or CatcarEous Concretions in the Urti- cCACEZ and other Piants. By H. A. Weppet, Aide- Naturaliste in the Jardin des Plants. (From the Annales d. Sc. Natur. Ser. [V., tom. ii, p. 267.) Axout the year 1827, J. Meyen discovered in the leaves of Ficus elastica, and of several other species belonging to the same genus, certain pedunculate corpuscles, constituted, as he supposed, of gum or of some analogous substance; he ascertained that these corpuscles increased by the super- position of new layers, and that ultimately they became covered with notches and elevations composed of a calcareous, crystal- line material, soluble with effervescence in acids (carbonate of lime). Long after this discovery by Meyen, M. Payen undertook the study of the same bodies, whose existence he demonstrated in a great many other plants belonging to the family of the Urticacee, and he concluded from his researches that their constituent material, which was regarded by Meyen as being of a gummy nature, was in fact cellulose, and that it was dis- posed, not in concentric groups, but in true cells united into racemose masses, each of which was destined for the secretion of a certain quantity of carbonate of lime. This view, which was adopted by several botanists, has been combated by others. Thus Schleiden, who was among the first to oppose it, appears IN THE URTICACEA. 81 to think that the corpuscles in question are analogous to the deposits which, in time, obstruct the cavity of certain hairs, in the Boraginee for instance ; and which, particularly in the common Fig, may be seen prolonged into the cavity of the bulb of the same kind of hairs. The cells in which the cor- puscles arise would even, according to Schleiden, be urticating hairs, whose base only was developed. The only argument which it is necessary to oppose to this theory, is the fact that the bodies in question are often seen beneath the epidermis and even in the medulla itself. Moreover, the deposit con- tained in the hairs of the Fig are formed in quite a different way from the gummy, calcareous, pedunculate corpuscles of Meyen, and behave towards reagents in a very different manner, More recently, again, Payen’s theory has found an anta- gonist in H. Schacht, to whom we are indebted for a very extended memoir on the subject. I shall content myself here with remarking, that he adds absolutely nothing essential to what Meyen had already stated with respect to the anatomical constitution of these corpuscles. Schacht, moreover, adopts entirely Payen’s opinion as regards their chemical constitution, and notices them besides as characterizing the tissue of another large family of plants—the Acanthacee—in which their pre- sence would seem to have been first shown by M. Gottsche of Altona. Lastly, I have myself for several years studied these sin- gular corpuscles ; and the result of my observations has also been completely in accord with that at which Meyen had arrived. Struck with the differences, which seemed to me to exist between these bodies developed in special cells, and all the other mineral secretions of plants, I gave them the name of cystolites (toric, Ooc). ‘These concretions, moreover, play a more important part in the physiognomy of the plants in which they occur than might at first be supposed, and are capable of furnishing the most valuable diagnostic characters ; it appeared a useful object, therefore, to describe them more clearly than had hitherto been done. Their figure is most commonly spheroidal ; but in many of the Urticacee, and in a great number of the Acanthacee, they assume an oblong or more or less linear form, attenuated towards the ends, sometimes in that of a bow, or more rarely of a horse-shoe shape. In the living plant they are visible only on dissection or by transmitted light; the leaves in which they are contained then exhibit when viewed with a magnify- ing glass, translucid lines or points, but from which it would scarcely be possible to draw any precise diagnostic characters. VOL. IV. G 82 WEDDEL, ON THE CYSTOLITES But this ceases to be the case when the plant is dried. The cystolites in fact do not contract in consequence of the desic- cation like the rest of the tissue of the leaf or stalk, but are in a certain sense protruded externally, and the delicate mem- branous tissue covering them is moulded so exactly upon them that it is difficult when viewing them in this condition, to believe, that they were previously concealed in the thickness of the organ. Many botanists, deceived, under these circum- stances, by their form, which is often linear, their white colour, and especially by the remarkable relief in which they stand, have described them as adnate hairs, others as Malpighian hairs, or lastly as simple tubercles. Gaudichaud was the first to recognise their mineral nature, regarding them, however, as true raphides, an opinion since adopted by several others, but which cannot sustain serious examination. Nevertheless the cystolites thus rendered visible on the exterior by the desic- cation, furnish specific and even generic characters of great value in so natural a family as that of the Urticacee. Among the genera belonging to this great group, in which these little bodies especially afford good characters, I would here parti- cularly notice the genus Plea, of which the species at present known amount to more than 100; and the genus Elatostema, which contains nearly 40. Another genus of Urticacee, Myriocarpa, may be recognised at once, and in the absence of the organs of fructification, by the radiated disposition of the cystolites around the base of the hairs which clothe the upper surface of the leaves. In all these plants the calcareous cor- puscles are, usually, more or less fusiform or linear; whilst in the greater part of the stinging Urticacee, in the Parietarie, and in the Béhmeria, they are nearly always spheroidal, pre- senting, in the dried plant, the aspect of projecting points, which often give to the leaf a certain asperity, which would be sought for in vain in the living plant. In all cases when studying the development of the sphe- roidal cystolites, I have had no difficulty in perceiving the pedicle, although it is sometimes very slender. This tenuity, however, of the suspensory filament is still greater in the linear cystolites ; so great, in fact, that Schacht declares that he has sought for it in vain. Nevertheless there is no doubt of its existence, at any rate in the first period of the development of the corpuscle, for if the cell be viewed from without to within, a minute point will always be observed on its exterior, evidently marking the insertion of the pedicle. It may happen, moreover, that the suspensory filament is eventually com- pletely concealed by the new layers successively added to the body of the concretion, which then appears to be sessile upon IN THE URTICACEX. 83 the wall of the cell in which it is produced. In this case it resembles, to a certain extent, a Malpighian hair developed in the interior of a cell. The size of these cystolites is extremely variable ; those of a linear or fusiform figure, nevertheless, commonly attain to much larger dimensions than the others. In several species of Pilea, 1 have observed some more than a millimetre in length ; whilst, on the other hand, there are some of a sphe- roidal form whose diameter scarcely reaches 2 to 3 1-100ths of a millimetre. I have often been able to demonstrate, and as it seems to me beyond the possibility of error, the concentrically laminated structure of the body of the cystolite ; but in no case have I been able to perceive in the pedicle the successive layers figured by Meyen and Schacht; it has always appeared to me to be a perfectly homogeneous appendage of the wall of the cell, and to arise from a circumscribed and continuous thick- ening of it. It behaves therefore towards reagents exactly in the same way as the substance of the wall itself, except per- haps that iodine develops, more frequently, traces of azotized matters. This fact did not escape the notice of Payen; and it cannot be doubted that this matter has something to do with the rapid development of these bodies. Perhaps the pedicle, directed towards the centre of the cavity of the cell, may act there like a foreign body, around which the calcareous matter is deposited. However this may be, the concretion and its pedicle always remain organically quite distinct. With respect to the physiological import of the cystolites, considered generally, it is a point not easily determined with precision; but if their situation, and the time at which they acquire their complete development (the fall of the leaf), and lastly, their chemical composition be considered, they would appear to be rather a sort of excretion, than a secretion useful in any of the functions of the plant. In this point of view, therefore, the cystolites may very properly be compared witb other mineral matters met with in the cells of plants, and in particular to those which occur in the crystalline form. Link, it is true, has compared the latter to the calculi occurring in animals ; but the analogy between certain of these calculi and the cystolites, appears to me much more remarkable. G2 ( 84 ) NOTES AND CORRESPONDENCE. The Circulation in Aqueous Plants.—In the 8th number of the Journal, published in July, 1854, there is an account of the circulation in the Closterium lunula, by the Hon. and Rey. Mr. Osborne, and Mr. Hogg. This circulation, according to Mr. Hogg, is “no new discovery,” but to me, as a young microscopist, I must confess it was so, as until I applied the parabolic reflector of Mr. Wenham, with the assistance of direct sunlight, | have never suspected it to exist. By this means of illumination, however, it appears to me to be very distinct, although I have seen it to better advantage in C. acerosum. Some time in April last I met with some good specimens of this plant, and with 41-inch objective of Smith and Beck their No. 1 eye-piece, Mr. Wenham’s reflector, and a prism instead of mirror, with the assistance of direct sunlight, I had repeatedly the gratification of beholding what Mr. Osborne appropriately calls a ‘‘ godlike” sight of the most beautiful, undulating ciliary motion, magnificently illuminated with prismatic colourings. After a longer time than usual spent over one specimen, the water in the cage partially dried, and on the edge of the air-bubble being brought by this means in close proximity with the specimen, the usual effect of external ciliary motion was most distinctly visible to myself and a friend for some considerable time, although no cilia could be distinguished. The rapid and continuous passage of a stream of molecules in the direction of the extreme end showed beyond the possibility of any doubt that cilia were there. A few days subsequently I met with a good sample of the Chara, and it struck me to examine the circulation by the same illumination I had so successfully employed with Clos- terium. Judge my delight when I found precisely the same appearances, the same rapid undulations, together with the same brilliant coruscations, that almost satisfied me that herein consisted the phenomenon of circulation in aqueous plants. I am not aware that this has before been noticed, or at any rate recorded, and hope some more practised observers will put it to the test; for whether I am correct in supposing the circulation in water-plants originates in ciliary movement or otherwise, they will be amply repaid for the trouble expended, in the glorious sight presented to them.—JamEs WESTERN, Veterinary Surgeon, Madras Artillery. MEMORANDA. 85 On the Starch Grain—In the Botan. Zeitung for June 8, 1855, p. 407, is a short notice, by O. Maschke, on the starch grain. Advertingto a paper ‘‘On the Structure of the Starch Granule,” by Mr. Grundy, which appeared in the ‘ Pharma- ceutical Journal for April 1855,’ the writer refers to his own researches on the subject, made in the years 1852 and 1853, and published in the ‘ Journal fiir praktische Chemie,’ vol. 56, part 7-8, and vol. 61, part 1; and states that in these communications he endeavoured to show :— 1. That the starch-grains are enveloped with cellulose, and consequently that they represent vesicles or cells. 2. That the starch-grains examined by him were constituted of several cells, arranged one with the other in a pill- box fashion. 3. That the amylon exists between these cells in a soluble or insoluble state, in the latter condition presenting the form of extremely minute granules. 4. That the so-termed nuclear point of the starch-grain is a central cavity in the innermost vesicle, which is sometimes empty in consequence of desiccation, and sometimes filled with fluid. 5. That the “ moss-starch” (moosstiarke) is merely amylon, modified by the action of acids (modified starch). 6. The “staleness” of bread depends upon the circumstance that the soluble starch, which exists in new-baked bread, passes into the insoluble condition. 7. That what is termed “leiocom” is produced simply from the action of an acid; and that this acid is formed in consequence of the elevated temperature necessary for the demonstration of this substance.” As the author does not appear, when these observations were made, to have been in possession of a good compound microscope, he may perhaps, when so furnished, see reason to change his opinion in some respects as to the structure of the starch-grain. Aperture of Object-glasses.—Professor Bailey having noticed in the last Journal my remarks bearing reference to the fact of his being able to discover the markings on the most difficult tests known, when mounted in balsam, I beg to state, that my observations were dictated by no other motive than the desire of establishing a correct fact, and that I was not pre- judiced by any favourite theory. Professor Bailey says, “‘ It is appparent from the above that Mr. Wenham has convinced himself, both by reason and 86 MEMORANDA. experiment, that I ought not to have seen the markings on delicate test objects, when mounted in balsam.” From this I infer that Professor Bailey had not seen a paragraph con- tained in my communication, in the ‘ Quarterly Journal of Microscopical Science’ for January, 1855, page 162, or I feel assured that he would not have thought it necessary to make this form of reply, for I therein assert that subsequent expe- rience had induced me to recall my remarks, and that I had lately succeeded in bringing out the strie of some very difficult tests when in balsam. I will now corroborate this by saying that I am convinced that Professor Bailey is per- fectly correct in his statement with respect to balsam tests, which must henceforth be recorded in the list of facts. Thus far we are quite agreed; but as Professor Bailey’s allusions extend beyond this point, self-defence will be my apology for taking some notice of them. Referring to me, Professor Bailey says, ‘‘ The error in his arguments will be sufficiently obvious to any one, who will trace the course of a divergent pencil of rays out of the balsam instead of into it, as in Mr. Wenham’s experiments, and it will then be seen, that large angles of aperture are as useful for balsam-mounted specimens as for others.” Surely Professor Bailey cannot have well considered this extraordinary, because extremely incorrect assertion, which is tantamount to saying, that a diverging pencil of rays from a luminous point, submerged in balsam, will in each case continue their course in the same right line, without suffering any refraction, after emerging from a plane surface of the medium. This is contrary to all reason, for in the trigonometry of optics where there are sufficient data con- nected with the position and direction of the rays, it comes to precisely the same thing whether they are traced into the refractive medium or oué of it. But taking Professor Bailey on his own statement, I will explain what is the real effect in this case. Suppose a series of rays diverging from a balsam- mounted object ; from the mean refraction of the balsam and glass cover (the indices being about 1°54 and 1°53) total reflection would take place from the upper surface of the latter at an angle of very nearly 41° from the perpendicular. This, therefore, at once limits the angle of rays collected by the object-glass to 82°, and as total reflection begins where refraction ceases, all rays beyond this point will be entirely reflected down again into the balsam, and lost by dispersion ; and the extreme rays of the pencil of 82° that just exceed total reflection by passing through the glass, so far from con- tinuing their course in a straight line, are brought down by refraction to the very level of the top surface of the cover MEMORANDA, 87 itself, so that if it were possible to use an objective of 180° of aperture, the effect of balsam-mounting would reduce it at once to 82°, and allowing for all possible variations of the refractive powers of the balsam and cover, I have no hesita- tion in affirming that any object mounted in the usual manner in this medium, has never been seen with an angle greater than 85°; but in all probability the extreme limit has been about 78°. This statement is not the result of mere hypo- thesis, but admits of ocular demonstration, by experiments that will prove it at least half-a-dozen different ways, and is so true in theory, that to endeavour to disprove it will be to take the difficult course, of attempting to undermine the ground upon which I have taken my stand, by denying the first laws of refraction upon which my assertion is based. Professor Bailey has, no doubt, experienced the advantage of the utmost extent of aperture that can be obtained, in that particular department of investigation, im which he has so eminently distinguished himself; and I am willing to admit, that if the highest powers are to be used only for viewing thin and flat objects like the Diatomacee, the aperture may be as near to 180° as may be practically convenient for this especial purpose ; but considering all the requirements, and perhaps more useful applications of the object-glass, I am still of opinion that beyond 150° there is no real advantage to be gained. I have expended much time, and taken special delight in the cultivation of the largest apertures, and possess an assortment ranging up to the greatest possible limit, and I can even now bring out striz with 150° as readily as with anything beyond it, with the positive advantage of a greater distance between the front lens and object. Some of the phenomena described in my communication to the present Journal are extremely severe tests of all the good qualities of an object-glass, and yet I have had some, whose performance is unrivalled upon a difficult diatomaceous test, repeatedly break down and fail in their effective duty, when applied to the investigation of plant-circulation, from the fact of their possessing too much aperture.—F’. H. Wennam. On the Structure of the frond of Polysiphonia fastigiata.— The frond of Polysiphonia fastigiata, bearing antheridia, consists of a mass of transparent matter, in which are imbedded coloured, elongated cells or siphons. These are so arranged side by side in successive rows as to surround a central hollow passing through the whole extent of the frond. Each row of siphons with its hyaline matrix forms a kind of ring or section of a tube, and under pressure has a tendency to detach itself from 88 MEMORANDA. those next to it. These rings are articulated by some inter- vening dark matter laid transversely. The tube thus formed is occupied by a series of clear vesicles of the same length as the siphons, which impress upon their outer surfaces a set of corresponding parallel depressions, and each vesicle contains an urn-shaped body of the same colour as the siphons. A row of spines is placed round the shoulder of this organ, and from either end a stem with a slightly-expanded termination passes out, by which all the vesicles and their contents are brought into connection. ‘These urn-shaped bodies when immedi- ately below a bifurcation of the frond are rather more squared than the rest, and give out a com- municating process from each of the distal angles. The chain is in this manner continued upwards. The contents in the conditions in which I have seen them are mere granular matter. The same or corresponding structures have not been observed in other species of Polysiphonia ; but in the frond of P. fastigiata, producing tetra- spores, they are present. No description or representa- tion of them has yet been pub- lished, and their functional rela- tions remain unknown. Polysiphonia. A. Terminal portion of a frond of Polysiphonia fastigiata, bearing antheridia. B. Transparent cells containing urn-shaped bodies from interior of frond. C. Urn-shaped body in cell from a part of the frond immediately below a bifurcation. Further remarks on the Fly’s Foot.—If M Yr. Tyrrell’s theory be correct, ‘‘ That the Fly uses the hooks as levers to detach the foot,” we should expect & priori that the Beetle did so: but the contrary is the fact. I placed one (not aquatic, or of the Curculio tribe) under the microscope, feet upwards, which was remarkably slow in its movements, and furnished with two circular pads, and one triangular, possessing trumpet- shaped hairs, and having the power of secreting fluid. When detaching the foot in walking, it raised the hooks first, and MEMORANDA. 89 kept them suspended for an appreciable length of time, before it raised the pads. I placed a blow-fly for examination, after having removed, under the influence of chloroform, the flap and two hooks of one foot, and about half the hooks of another: it could not attach the foot with one flap efficiently ; but the one in which the hooks were so far shortened, that they extended only to the middle of the flaps, it used very well. Query, Would not the flap have beer. torn through, and half left on the glass, in this case, if the above theory were correct ? When the foot of the Midge (one of the Tipulide) is in action, it has the appearance of a horse’s foot in miniature. I believe the Walrus, although it sometimes exceeds a ton in weight, has a similar apparatus to the Midge, by which it can support itself on the almost perpendicular sides of the immense icebergs it has to traverse. The Midge’s foot terminates in a single sucker, and has no hooks wherewith to detach itself.—J. Herpwortn, Croft's Bank. Microscopic Preparations.— From a notice in the Botanische. Zeitung for November 10, 1854, we perceive that Dr. J. Speerschneider, of Blankenburg, near Rudolstadt, in Thuringia, proposes, apparently with the co-operation of Professor V. Schlechtendal, to issue a collection of microscopical prepara- tions, intended to exhibit the most important points with respect to the structure and development of plants. The entire collection will contain ten to twelve dozen preparations, and will be issued in five to six parts, each of which will cost only three Prussian thalers; and subscribers’ names may be sent either to Dr. Speerschneider, as above, or to Professor Schlechtendal, at Halle. ie as, PROCEEDINGS OF SOCIETIES. Mricroscoricaut Society, May 28rd. On a new form of Microscope. By Ropert Wartncron, Esq. In carrying on the observations in my small Aquarium, which have for some time past occupied my leisure hours, I was very anxious to bring the microscope to my aid in examining the minute organ- isms or delicate structures of the creatures I had the opportunity of noticing, and which had been maintained for a considerable period in a healthy condition; at the same time it was important to do this without disturbing them from the natural position they had taken up, or removing them from the water. It occurred to me that I could best effect this object by attaching the microscope to the edge of the table, on which the aquarium was placed, by means of a clamp, and that by shifting this along before the front of the tank I could range over all the objects situated at that part. In searching among some old chemical apparatus for a clamp likely to be suited for this purpose, I happily found one that had been employed for carrying the plates or subjects in an electrotyping trough, and which appeared exactly adapted for the object I had in view, being fitted with two ears which projected from the back, and through each of which a circular hole was drilled for carrying a rod, one of them being supplied with a binding screw for the purpose of adjusting it to any desired length. As this clamp fitted well to the edges of the table, I had only to get an ordinary micro- scope body arranged, with a cradle-joint and circular rod attached to the back and end of the bar which usually carries the rack and pinion of the coarse adjustment, and the desired requirements were . fulfilled. By this means several motions of the instrument were obtained : first, the power of elevation or depression, by means of the rod, in the front of the tank ; second, the focussing for distance by the rack and pinion; third, angularity in the position of the body by the cradle-joint ; fourth, the traversing motion along the margin of the table, and also a curvilinear motion of the instrument by the rotation of the circular rod in the back of the clamp. This object having been completed to my satisfaction, it next became a question whether the instrument, with a few additions, could not be turned to more general utility as a travelling micro- scope, particularly for use at the sea-side. To effect this I procured a small flat block of wood having an upright piece fashioned at right angles across its upper surface, on the edge of which the clamp or saddle could be screwed, and the body of the instrument, being adjusted at right angles to the rod, thus brought to act over any vessel, as a saucer or plate, containing the object to be examined ; the length of the rod being the limit of the distance over which it would range. This arrangement rendered the instru- ment doubly useful, and was found to realize all my anticipations. PROCEEDINGS OF SOCIETIES. 91 The next step in its further development arose from the observa- tion, that, when the wooden biock was set upright, on the angle formed by the strut, or projecting ridge, and the bed, it inclined nearly at the angle, or diagonal direction, in which the microscope is usually employed, and that by shortening the block slightly on one side of the ridge the most comfortable position for observation could be readily secured; the clamp or saddle carrying the body being then attached over the upper extremity of the block. It therefore merely required a stage and mirror to render the instru- ment serviceable in this new form. This was effected, keeping the portability of the result always in mind, by inserting into the under surface of the block, at a proper distance, a dovetailed socket for the reception of an elongation, or tongue, of a moveable stage-plate, and below this a small ferrule was introduced for carry- ing the rod of the mirror. It was also found that, by elongating the rod, and craning the body of the instrument over into a vertical position, it might be employed as a dissecting microscope ; the only addition that was required being the insertion of another dovetailed socket into the block to carry the stage-plate in a horizontal position. With these various adaptations to the circumstances as they presented them- selves, the little instrument assumed its perfect form. As this original microscope was of inconvenient size and weight, and as there was no apparent reason why these objections could not be easily obviated, I determined to have a new one made, maintain- ing the same form and construction, but reducing the weight and dimensions wherever it was practicable; the result has been the small instrument which was submitted to the Members of the Society on Wednesday last, and which I shall now proceed to describe in detail. The block, or bed, is made of oak, or other heavy wood, of about half an inch in thickness, and is 74 inches long by 3 inches wide. Into this are countersunk the two brass dovetailed sockets, the diagonal one, or that which carries the stage plate in a diagonal position, and at right angles to the bed, at 34 inches from the upper edge, the horizontal one at 3 inches; the cireular socket for receiv- ing the rod of the mirror being inserted about 14 inch from the lower edge. At the back of the block are introduced two circular ferrules, 3} inches from the top, for the reception of two strong pins, which connect the strut, or upright piece, with the bed ; this arrangement enables us to remove this from its position, and to pack the whole in a much smaller compass. In the side of the bed is also inserted another ferrule to receive the pin of a condensing Jens for concentrating the light on the stage for opaque objects, or for the same purpose between the source of light and the mirror, it is placed 23 inches from the top. The strut, or upright piece, is of the same width and thickness as the bed, and 34 inches in heighth, having two strong pins inserted for connection with the main piece. The stage is a single stout plate of brass, of the same width as 92 PROCEEDINGS OF SOCIETIES. the bed, and 33 inches deep, bevelled at its sides, and having a short tongue, or elongation, at the lower edge, for insertion into either of the dovetailed sockets; it has a large central aperture, and is provided with a light cross-piece, fitting on the bevelled sides of the stage, and capable of moving easily up or down, for carrying the object-slides ; at the right-hand corner of the stage there is also a small aperture, with a saw cut through its edge, for the reception of the pin of a pair of forceps. The small condenser may also be inserted below the stage into this aperture, so as to condense the rays from the source of light to the mirror, or between the mirror and the stage. The clamp, or saddle, should be made as small and as light as is compatible with the thickness of the wooden bed, or stand, and the weight which the screws have to maintain firm and steady. The body is constructed of two tubes sliding the one within the other, so as to allow of its elongation to its proper length when in use. The outer one of these is embraced by a short tube two inches long, lined with cloth, and through which the body tube should have a steady and easy motion, as that forms the coarse adjustment. To the lower edge of this tubular support is soldered the cradle- joint with its attached rod; the latter being five inches in length. The fine adjustment, which I believe is new, is situated just above the object-glass ; it is constructed on the principle of a common union-joint, the outer half of which works in a male screw at the extremity of the body-tube, and acts against a spring in order to maintain a constant bearing, thus :—A is the lower part of the body-tube, having a ring of metal as a stop in its interior, at 1, against which the spring, 3, bears, and having a screw on its exterior, at the lower aperture, for the half-union, C, to work in. JB is the tube which re- ceives the object-glass at its lower aperture, and has a ring of metal at- tached to its upper extremity, within the body-tube, at a, for the bearing of the lower coil of the spring, 3; it has also a slight projection on its exterior, near the object-glass, which is embraced by the curved extremity of the half-union, C. The great object in this arrangement was to avoid the projection of a screw-head, which in packing away the instrument generally takes up so much space. By these modifications the whole instru- ment, together with a live-box, two object-glasses, the condensing lens, and the forceps, enclosed in a leather case, occupies a space of 8 inches Jong, by 3 wide and 3 deep; so that it can be easily carried in the coat-pocket. The cost is estimated at about £3 for the microscope complete, including the packing-case, without the powers ; or with two French achromatics, at 15s. additional. ( 93) ZOOPHYTOLOGY. In Johnston’s ‘ History of British Zoophytes,’ six genera of Vesiculariadan Polyzoa are described, but of which one, Beania, is more properly referrible to the cheilostomatous sub-order. To these have subsequently been added two or three others ; as Avenella, by Sir J. Dalzell, Mimosella by the Rey. T. Hincks, and, more recently, a form described under the name NVolella, by Mr. Gosse. To this number we have now to add another generic form, new to the British Fauna, and a new species belonging apparently to the established genus Farrella, although the characters of that genus, as assigned to it by Van Beneden, will require some modification for its admission. Order. PoLyz0a INFUNDIBULATA. Sub-order III, Crenostomata (VESICULARINA). Fam. 1, VESICULARIADZ. § 2. Polypides without a gizzard. Gen. 1. Farrella, Ehrenberg. Lagenella, Farre. Laguncula, Van Beneden. Char. Cells oblong or tubulous, scattered, arising from a creeping sto- toniferous tube. Farrella gigantea, Busk (n. sp.). Pl. V., figs. 1, 2. Cells tubulous, sessile, not contracted at the base; tentacles numerous (18—20). ctocyst flocculent, rendered opaque by imbedded earthy matter. Hab. Tenby. This very distinct form is characterized, in the first place, by the comparatively enormous length of the cells, which occasionally exceed 1-10th of an inch in length ; and secondly, by the peculiar constitution of the wall or ectocyst. This is not horny and transparent, as in most of the other Vesiculari- dans, but appears to be of a soft, flocculent texture, in which is imbedded, as it were, an abundance of earthy matter, apparently derived from the mud in the water in which the creature lives, and consequently composed for the most part of argillaceous and silicious particles. A similar constitution of the ectocyst is observed in Anguinella palmata, and may therefore be expected to occur in others of the same family. This peculiarity of the ectocyst, and the extraordinary length of the cells, appear to constitute the chief distinctive charac- ters between Farrella gigantea and what I take to be the Avenella (Farrella) fusca of Sir J. Dalzell. For specimens 94 ZOOPHYTOLOGY. of the latter species I am indebted to Mr. Wyville Thomp- son; and from one of these, fig. 8, Pl. VI., has been taken for the purpose of comparison; the two having been drawn under the same magnifying power. It should be remarked, however, that the specimen of the latter here figured was in the dry state, and consequently is somewhat distorted. But since these figures were printed I have met with a species of Farrella, parasitic upon Flustra foliacea, dredged in about 20 fathoms of water off Tenby, which appears to correspond with the Avenella fusca, and the examination of which in the living state has satisfied me beyond doubt, that that form and Farrella gigantea are quite distinct. In the ‘ Annals of Nat. Hist.,’ 2nd Ser., vol. xvi., p. 35, Plate IV., fig. 29, Mr. Gosse describes and figures a Polyzoan belonging to the same family, under the name of Nolella, which would appear closely to approach in some respects, as he himself observes, the Avenella of Sir J. Dalzell; and from the semiopacity assigned to the ectocyst, it would also seem to correspond very closely with the form above adverted to, as found upon Flustra foliacea. ‘The characters, however, assigned by Mr. Gosse to Nolella are apparently sufficient to remove all suspicion of this being the case. He says, that the “ cells are erect, subcylindrical, springing singly, but closely from an undefined polymorphous incrusting mat ; the tentacles (18) forming a bell.’ A copy of Mr. Gosse’s figure of LV. stipata is given in Plate V., fig. 4. What is meant precisely by the expression “ undefined, polymorphous incrusting mat,” from which the cells spring, is not very clear. In all known Vesiculariadan Polyzoa, except Anguinella, the cells spring “ singly” from a common tube; and if, as the use of the word “‘ mat” might imply, the ‘“‘ polymorphous crust” is composed of tubes, the character is intelligible enough, and the species in accordance, so far, with its congeners ; but if, as the expression might also be taken to convey, and as the figure certainly indicates, this crust is a continuous substance,—the condition is so peculiar as at once to raise the genus in which it is found to the rank of, at least, a distinct family group. It is more probable, however, that upon farther examination Mr. Gosse will find that the cells do really arise from a creeping adnate tube ; in which case the genus will fall to the ground, and Woledla stipata have to be referred to Farrella, with the characters as here modi- fied. If so, it would seem to correspond in all respects with Avenella fusca, Dalzell; or, at any rate, with the form occur- ring in Flustra foliacea above noticed, and which, if not the Avenella, is apparently as yet undescribed. ZOOPHYTOLOGY. 95 Between Farrella (Laguncula) elongata, V. B. (Rech. sur les Bryozoair.), p. 26, Pl. IL. (6), of which an outline sketch (reduced from the original figure) is given in Plate VL, fig. 4, and F. gigantea, the difference is sufficiently obvious. This species has not yet, so far as I am aware, been observed upon the British coast, though it will in all probability be found to be a native. The only situation in which F. gigantea has as yet been met with is in the neighbourhood of Tenby, and there chiefly in a cave in St. Catherine’s Isle, which is only open at spring tides. In the autumn of 1854 the walls of this cave were in parts densely covered with this Polyzoan, growing in a close and thick pile, but inconspicuous among the numerous Sponges and minute vermidoms of similar colour and aspect, with which the surface of rock is covered. In the present year, however, the species is far less abundant in the same locality. The species, as has been said, is remarkable for the gigantic size of the cells, which are often more than 1-10th of an inch in length, ‘The polypide, however, is not beyond the average size in other Polyzoa, It has from 20 to 30 long slender, highly flexible tentacles. Gen. 2. Anguinella, V. B. Rech. sur les Bryoz., p. 58. Char. Cells tubulous, cylindrical, supported on a common stem (one springing from the base of another). A, palmata, V.B. Pl. VI., figs. 1, 2. The only species— A. palmata, V. Bened. Rech. sur les Bryoz., p. 58. Pl. VII., figs. , 24. Hab. Ostend, Van Beneden; Britain, Busk; River Deben, Suffolk ; Tenby ; Charleston, 8. Carolina, U. S., Harvey. The very peculiar conformation of the polyzoary in this species at once distinguishes it from all its congeners. It is farther distinguished from most of them by the constitution of the ectocyst, which contains imbedded in a soft, or rather flocculent substance, so large a quantity of argillaceous and silicious matter, that when exposed to the flame of a spirit lamp, it is converted into a kind of red earthenware, retaining its pristine form and dimensions, or nearly so. It grows to a large size; many tufts or bunches reaching three or four inches in length. It is found on dead or living shells, and on stones, and closely resembles a small Fucus covered with mud. This peculiar colour and habit have probably been the reason that it has so long escaped notice on our coasts, where it will, in all probability, be found to 96 ZOOPHYTOLOGY. be pretty generally distributed, especially in muddy situations. Its wide distribution in the world is indicated by its occur- rence at such a distant locality as South Carolina, the speci- mens from which in my possession were collected by Dr. Harvey. In the river Deben, in Suffolk, which is more properly speaking an estuary than a river, scarcely a dead or living oyster-shell can be dredged up which is not covered by it. At Tenby it occurs, very sparingly, in the caves in St. Catherine’s Isle. ZOOPHY TOLOGY. DESCRIPTION OF FIGURES. PLATE VY. Fig. 1.—Farrella gigantea, natural size. 2.—The same magnified. 3.—Mouth of cell, with the polypide partially extruded. 4,.—Nolella stipata, Gosse. Puate VI. 1.—Anguinella palmata magnified. 2.—Portion of cell, with polypide partially extruded. 3.—Outline sketch of Avenella fusca, which had been dried and com- pressed. 4,—Outline sketch of Farrella (Laguncula) elongata, Van Beneden. rok, ORIGINAL COMMUNICATIONS. On Certain Conpitions of the Denrat Tissues. By Joun Tomes, F.R.S., Surgeon-Dentist to the Middlesex Hospital. Tue temporary teeth, when about to be replaced by the per- manent set, lose their fangs by gradual absorption of their substance. The crown, when thus left, having but little hold upon the gum, soon falls out. The manner in which the absorption of the dental tissues is effected has been described in a paper published in the ‘“ Philosophical Transactions,” in 1853. The subject is there mentioned in connection with the absorption of bone. Having latterly had occasion to devote considerable attention to the phenomena attending the casting off of the deciduous teeth, several conditions relative to absorption have come under my notice, which, as applied to teeth, had, I think, hitherto escaped observation, It may, however, be here stated, that the more recent examinations have not led to any modification of the opinions upon the subject of absorption advanced in the paper alluded to, but have served rather to confirm the statement there made. Absorption may com- mence upon any part of the fangs of a tooth, and at several points at the same time. By the gradual extension of this process, both in depth and superficially, the root of the tooth is wasted, till, at last, nothing is left but the crown, and even this part is often so much hollowed out, that, excepting the enamel, but little of the tooth remains. The cementum is first attacked, then the dentine disappears, and the enamel at those points where the denfine has been entirely removed suffers from the same action. But whichever of the three tissues is attacked, we see the same characteristic surface as that shown by bone when undergoing a similar action, namely, a surface full of deep indentations, as though they had been made by a sharp piercing instrument, haying a semicircular extremity. These minute holes or depressions proceed in various directions, several advancing from contrary points towards the same spot, not unfrequently isolate pieces of dentine. If a setion be taken through the substance of a tooth, so as to cut the wasting part at a right angle, we shall find the surface acted upon to have an irregular festooned outline, so characteristic, that when once seen it cannot fail to be again recognised. VOL. IV. H 9§ TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. It has been stated that, closely applied to the surface, a cellular mass will be found, and that this is but slightly adherent, the wasting and growing surfaces readily parting, unless the two are held together by the irregularities on the surface of the former. It will sometimes happen that the cellular mass penetrates into the dentine through a small open- ing, and there dilates, in which case its withdrawal becomes impossible. This condition is now and then found on sec- tions prepared for the microscope, when we have an oppor- tunity of examining the two tissues in situ. Indeed we shall find a few cells adherent to the surface of the dentine where less deep burrowing has occurred. The cells themselves do not present any peculiarity by which they could be readily recognised, if separated from the part undergoing removal. They are small granular cells, of a more or less spherical form. If a tooth which has lost its fang be carefully re- moved, we shall find remaining in its place a growing papilla, corresponding exactly in size and form to the surface from which it has been separated ; and this separation may often be effected with so little injury to the absorbent organ, that no blood appears upon its surface after the operation, although the organ is highly vascular and readily torn.* The superficial extent of the papilla will be equal to that part of the tooth undergoing waste, but the extent, as regards depth, is slight, for, as the root of the tooth disappears, the socket is con- tracted by the deposition of bone, which forms at the base of the absorbent organ as rapidly as the cellular surface en- croaches upon the tooth, The cases in which we find an exception to this condition are those in which the permanent has advanced close to the fangs of the temporary tooth, when the crypt containing the one communicates with the socket of the other, the rate of growth of the permanent having been greater than the absorption of the deciduous organ; but even in these cases we may generally observe some part in which the con- traction of the socket is coincident with the absorption of the occupant fang, From the followmg quotation, it does not appear that Mr. Bell observed these conditions :— “Tt has been already stated, that the permanent teeth during their formation are crowded tugether in the jaw, by being placed in a smaller arch than they would occupy if regularly placed side by side. As the latter, however, is their destined situation, we find that as soon as they are advanced to a certain point of their formation, and can no longer be contained within the alveoli, absorption takes place in the anterior parietes * Laforgue and Bourdet recognised the presence of the absorbent organ, but supposed it exhaled a fluid capable of dissolving the roots of the temporary tooth. TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. 99 of the cavities, by which means the teeth are allowed to come in some measure forward. In consequence of this absorption it often happens, that not only the socket of the corresponding temporary tooth, but that of the tooth on each side is also opened to the permanent one. Absorption now commences in the root of the temporary tooth, generally on that part nearest its successor, and thus goes on by degrees as the latter advances, until the root is completely removed, the crown at length falls off, leaving room for the permanent tooth to supply its place.” Mr. Bell, however, rejects the idea that mere pressure of the one tooth against the other has anything to do with the absorption of the first set; an opinion that he would probably have expressed even more strongly, had he observed the shallow but perfect sockets which are formed when the tem- porary teeth are shed before their successors are ready to appear. This, however, must be a very common condition, as I have in my own collection several specimens illustrating the point. The fact was not overlooked, I think, by Hunter, although his description is not very clear. He states at page 99 in his ‘Natural History of the Teeth:’ “The new alveoli rise with the new teeth, and the old alveoli decay in proportion as the old teeth decay ; and when the first set falls out, the succeed- ing teeth are so far from having destroyed by their pressure the parts against which they might be supposed to push, that they are still enclosed and covered by a complete bony socket. From this we see that the change is not produced by a mechanical pressure, but by a particular process in the animal economy.” But there is still a disposition on the part of many who are intrusted with the treatment of teeth, to attribute the absorp- tion of the roots of the one tooth to pressure occasioned by the growth of its successor, and the development of the per- manent may have something to do with the shedding of the other. But this does not offer a satisfactory explanation of all the circumstances attending the absorption of the fangs of teeth. In the first place we sometimes meet with cases in which the fangs of permanent teeth are as completely ab- sorbed as those of the temporary organs. Then, again, the fangs of temporary teeth, which have no successors, are also absorbed. These circumstances, taken with the hitherto overlooked fact, that with the waste of the temporary tooth we have pretty generally a corresponding development of bone within the socket to be removed before the permanent tooth appears through the gum, render the pressure theory somewhat unsatisfactory. Another condition may be ad- duced, tending also against that opinion, namely, that tem- porary teeth occasionally maintain their place to the exclusion Hee 100 TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. of the permanent ones, which are then kept within the substance of the jaw, or appear in some unusual posi- tion. The relations as regards time between the absorption and shedding of temporary teeth and the appearance of the suc- ceeding permanent teeth, are by no means constant. In some cases the temporary teeth are thrown off two years before the corresponding permanent ones come through the gums. In others, again, the new will replace the old ones in as many weeks or even days. Before the laws which regulate the absorption of the fangs of teeth can be fully recognised, a more perfect knowledge of the condition attending the process must be acquired. Recent examinations have enabled me to add the following additional facts bearing upon this subject to those already known. The process of absorption once commenced, it appears to have been assumed that the same action would be continued, with more or less rapidity, until the tooth falls out; or if not continual, is suspended only. Such, however, is not constantly the case. Not only is the action of absorp- tion suspended, but one of development takes its place. We find the excavated surface of the dentine cementum and enamel covered with cementum, the latter following all the irre- gularities of the former tissues, and closely united to them. In cases where this development is going on, or being set up is maintained, the teeth afford considerable resistance when their removal is attempted. In those instances where the first teeth have remained, and tend to the displacement of the second set, this deposit of cementum will be found to exist in considerable quantity. The development of bone upon the surface which had formerly been the seat of absorption, by no means indicates that the tooth will not again be subject to destructive action. On the contrary, specimens in my collection show that the bone deposited under the above circumstances may itself become the subject of absorption, that this process may be again suspended and development be renewed, that the absorp- tion may again take the place of development; in fact, that wasting and reparation may alternate until by the preponder- ance of the former the tooth is shed. In sections of teeth showing this peculiar condition of development, we may find upon the growing bone numerous osteal cells, with here and there a lacunal cell. A bone dacuna, situated within a semi- circular indentation in the dentine, gives the appearance of a lacunal cell, and a dacuna similarly situated in the cementum (a circumstance of common occurrence), has possibly been TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. 101 supposed by Mr. J. Salter to be what has been described in the paper before referred to as a lacunal cell.* The part of a tooth which has the greatest power of resisting absorption, is that in immediate contact with the pulp. We find examples in which a thin shell of dentine surrounds that organ, while that around it has been in great part taken away. This is, however, eventually removed, and the pulp itself changes its character, and becomes an absorbent organ, or makes way for that which is. In a fortunate selection we may find sec- tions showing in one part dentine which has been but recently formed, with its modular outline and contiguous cells, capable of developing dentine; in another part absorption im active progress ; and in a third the deposition of bone on the surface of the wasted dentine. In no instance, however, have I seen dentine deposited upon the surface of that which has been diminished by absorption. It would appear that the dentinal pulp, although its func- tion may be clhianged into that of absorption, or its place be taken by an absorbent organ, and this, again, changed to one for the development of bone, is incapable of resuming under any recognised circumstances its prumary function of dene development. In other words, that a portion of dentine when remoyed by absorption, cannot be replaced ;+ while in bone, or cementum, the removal of a lost portion is of frequent occur- rence. Sections taken from the teeth of adults seldom fail to exhibit points where the cementum has been removed and again added ; and very commonly the absorption has at points extended a short distance into the dentine, and the lost parts made good with cementum. This condition may be observed in perfectly sound teeth; but in unsound ones, where the cementum exceeds the normal amount, the removal and renewal of tissue is still more marked. Hf the section be so made as to give a view of the surface of the pulp cavity, we shall probably find evidence of the pulp after the full develop- * Transactions of the Pathological Society, vol. vi., p. 169. + Since the manuscript was sent to the Editors of this Journal, I have seen a paper published in the last number of the Guy’s Hospital Re eports, by Mr. J. Salter, ‘On Intrinsic Calcification of the Permanent Tooth- pulp. Mr. Salter describes a section taken from a carious temporary molar, which was removed from the mouth of a person aged 18 years. The author states, that the ‘‘ pulp was found converted into a mass of crusta petrosa and dentine confounded together.” The drawing is beauti- fully executed, and shows, by the usual indications, that the pulp-cavity has been enlarged by absorption of its parietes. Judging from a view of the engraving only, it would appear that the tissue in contact with the wasted dentine is cementum only, while the newly-developed dentine is limited to the inner portion of the mass. If this view be correct, the specimen would have served for the illustration of the present paper. 102 TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. ment of the tooth, having resumed its full formative powers, and produced new, or secondary dentine, the action having been excited either by the wearing away of the tooth or by the presence of caries. If the irritation be continued until it extends down the fang as far as its extremity, and signs of inflammation show themselves, the aperture of the fang will become enlarged by absorption, and after awhile the enlargement is continued to a considerable distance up the root of the tooth. The canal may be again contracted by the formation of dentine, or by the development of cementum ; and Ihave seen one or two instances in which the greater part of the pulp cavity in permanent teeth has been lined with cementum. This condition of tissues is very common in teeth that have been long the subject of caries, but I believe it is not confined to carious teeth. I have several specimen of temporary teeth, in which the lower part of the root has suffered from absorption, and then has become the seat of deposition of cementum, leaving only a small canal in the centre. High up the root small patches of dentine have been removed, some of which only have been made good with cementum, while the contiguous parts have retained their usual condition. It will be seen that the foregoing facts bear upon the opinions advanced by Mr. De Morgan and myself, in the paper on the structure and development of bone, before cited ; that we have indications in teeth, as in bone, of alter- nations, of removal, and deposition of tissue. In the young subject, the development of bone tissue is in excess of absorp- tion, allowing the bones to increase in size ; that in middle life the two powers, under ordinary circumstances, balance each other, and the bones preserve their adult dimensions ; while in old age the absorbent action appears to prepon- derate. Conditions pretty nearly parallel occur in the dental tissues after the temporary tooth has been fully formed ; por- tions of cementum are removed, and with it, in some cases, a little dentine; the lost parts are replaced by cementum, and the tooth is again perfect. When the time approaches for shed- ding the teeth, the two actions alternate; but the absorption being in excess of the development, the tissues disappear, and the tooth is shed. After the formation of the permanent teeth we have occasional alternatives of the two actions; but they are balanced, and neither increase or diminution of size is observed. But as age comes on, it often happens that absorption is in excess, the fangs diminished in size, the teeth become loose, and fall out. TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. 103 Observations on the Structure of the Enamel. Without going fully into the structure and development of the enamel, and into the citations of the opinions published upon the subject, I wish to take this opportunity of recording certain observations which I have made upon that structure. The transverse striation of the enamel fibres has been fre- quently remarked, but the cause of these markings has not been determined. If sections from a number of teeth be examined, it will be found that the strie are much more strongly pronounced in some specimens than in others, and most especially so in those in which parts of the tissue have a brown colour when seen by transmitted light. The markings crossing the direction of the fibres are of two descriptions. The one arranged in contour lines, and situated at irregular distances from each other, uncertain in number and extent, and sometimes altogether absent. The other kind minute and regular, extending from fibre to fibre, and strongly resembling the transverse markings in voluntary muscle. In the present instance my remarks will be confined to the latter kind of markings. In unhealthy subjects the permanent teeth, when they appear through the gums, are not unfrequently destitute of the brilliant white colour common to the finely-developed organs of a healthy child; on the contrary, they have an opaque yellow colour. If such teeth be selected for examination, we shall find that the sockets, when reduced sufficiently thin to be seen by transmitted light, present in the enamel a confused opaque appearance; but if a tolerably high power be used (such as the quarter or eighth object-glass) in conjunction with a strong light, the dark appearance will resolve itself into a series of lines; the one set marking the course of the fibres, the other taking the direction of the transverse strieg. The two sets of lines crossing each other at right angles leave inter- spaces approaching a square form. These interspaces are fitted with granular masses, having the appearance of cells. By treating the section carefully with dilute hydrochloric acid, these appearances become more distinct, and we then have series of parallel fibres composed of distinct sheaths, each containing a line of granular cells or meshes arranged in a single series, presenting a strong resemblance to the ultimate fibrilea of muscles. That such is the true structure of enamel is, I think, satisfactorily proved by specimens in my collections, some of which show the cells or granular masses; whilst others show the sheath, with the contents removed. Other specimens, again, show the enamel fibres in 104 TOMES, ON THE DENTAL TISSUES. the very young subject, deprived of their salts, detached from each other, and floating about in the fluid in which the section is preserved. The figures illustrating these forms were drawn from specimens which retain the conditions figured. The appear- ances described do not admit of dispute; but the interpre- tation of their origin may perhaps be differently given by observers who do not agree upon the manner in which the enamel is developed. I do not propose to enter upon the question of development; but shall for the present leave the subject, after stating the varying conditions of enamel as it is found in human teeth. In well-formed teeth, although the cell-like markings in the enamel are not by any means as distinct as in ee in the condition I have described; yet having first examined the latter, but little difficulty will be experienced in recognising here andl there faint indications of a similar structure, espe- cially if the light be well managed. The more perfect the development of the tooth, the more transparent and free from markings will be the enawiel when seen as a inicruscopic object ; and the less perfect que more distant will be the columns of granular cell-fibres. Examples may readily be found in which the union be- tween the enamel fibres is so defective that the tissue readily breaks down; a condition rendering it very difficult to grind it sufficiently thin for microscopic examination, When ob- tained, however, such specimens are very instructive, as they show distinctly the individual fibres and their contents, which in the most highly-developed tissue are so perfectly fused together, that the strongly-marked distinction of parts, which is so obvious in the one, is almost entirely lost in the other. From what has been stated it will be seen that my view of the structure of enamel is as follows :— The enamel fibres are composed of a sheath containing a series of cells or masses; that in perfectly-developed enamel, the cells or masses and sheaths are so blended that but slight distinction of parts remains, but that in less perfectly de- veloped tissue the component parts remain visible. (To be continued.) ON THE FILAMENTOUS, LONG-HORNED DIATOMACE. 105 On the FtnamMentous, Lonc-HorNED Diaromacem, with a De- scription of two new species. By Tuomas Brieutwe t, F.LS. In a gathering of Diatomacex, made by the late Mr. Wigham in July 1854, on the borders of the salt-water estuary, called Breydon, near Yarmouth, a singular filamentous, horned species was detected, allied to the genus Chetoceros of Ehrenberg. An examination of this singular organism, (the first of the family which has occurred in this country), and a comparison of it with the allied forms described by Ehrenberg and Dr. Bailey, afford materials calculated to extend and correct our knowledge of this rather doubtful group of Diatomacee. Mr. Wigham’s discovery will also, we trust, induce surviving labourers in the same field, to endeavour to add to our know- ledge of existing species, as much must yet be brought to light before a satisfactory classification of this group can be effected. Most of the described species have been found only in a fossil, or rather, if we may so term it, a deposit state ; and in this state it is clearly difficult to form a correct idea of either species or genera, since deposits give no information as to the Diatoms being in threads or solitary frustules. From this circumstance, and a disposition to describe every variety of form, and even many fragments of Diatoms, as species, both species and genera have been multiplied to a perplexing extent. It appears probable that there are few, if any, instances of truly fossil Diatoms, but that all the so-called fossil species are only deposits from still-existing and living species ; and it is only when we have the living Diatom before us, that we can give any specific or generic characters that can be at all relied upon.* The discovery of a new and living species of Chetoceros, and a careful examination of most of the species of this and seve- ral other allied genera, described by Ehrenberg as found in a fossil state, have satisfied us that most, if not all these, will, when found in a living state, turn out to belong to the singu- lar filamentous and horned group, which may for the present, with some extension of its character (such as is hereafter attempted in this paper), be comprehended in the genus Chetoceros. The typical species of Ehrenberg’s genus appears to be C. * In proof of this, Ehrenberg’s genus Liblarum seems entirely composed of the disjecta membra of several genera, as Tetracyclus, Odontidiwm, and some others, Tetracyclus emarginatus, Wm. Smith, (Biblarum emargina- tum, Khr.,) has been found recently, in a living state, both in Ireland and Scotland. 106 BRIGHTWELL, ON THE FILAMENTOUS, didymus. This occurs not unfrequently in guano. The horns proceed immediately from apertures on each side of the frus- tules (an essential character of Ehrenberg’s genus), and differ in this respect from our newly-discovered species, in which the horns proceed from, or rather are an elongation of the intermediate rings. Two species from the Antarctic Sea are briefly described by Ehrenberg (C. dicheta and C. tetracheta); each frustule is smooth, and the horns (of which the former species has two on each side, and the latter four) are very long and filiform. These species were, we believe, found in pancake-ice, and were brought home by Dr. J. D. Hooker. Two species from Bermuda earth, marked as doubtful, are described by Dr. Bailey (C. bacillaria and C. diploneiis), and he has also recently described and figured a remarkable species, named by him C. boreale, found in the stomach of Botriodactyla grandis.* The horns of this species are very long, and armed with numerous minute spines. Dr. Bailey describes and figures a small species also found in guano, named by him C. ineurvum, which we have found plentiful in South American guano, Of the allied genus Goniothecium, eight species are de- scribed by Ehrenberg, all found in the Richmond earth, North America. The two largest and most common are G. Rogersit and G. odontella, and we think it probable these will turn out, if discovered in a recent or living state, to be Chetocert. Of the remaining six species, we are led to conclude, from the discovery of the Breydon species, that two of them belong to the genus Chetoceros, and are, wher living, filamentous. ‘They are Gontothecium gastridium, of which we have found many specimens with the horns perfect, and G. crenatum. A figure of a frustule of this species is given in the Microgeologie of Ehrenberg ; and it can scarcely be distinguished from the frustules of the Breydon species. Similar frustules are of fre- quent occurrence in African and other guano, and in several fossil earths of marine formation, and we have detected recent specimens in a gathering lately sent us from Monterey Bay, North America. Gontothectum hispidum and G. didymum of Ehrenberg, scarcely appear to differ from some of the smaller frustules of the Breydon species. G. navicula and G. barbatum are marked by Ehrenberg as doubtful species of Goniothectum ; but are clearly allied to G. erenatum, or our Breydon species. Several other fossil genera of Ehrenberg contain species which will probably be found to belong to the long-horned filamentous Diatoms. Xanthiopyxis cingulata Jas precisely * See Smithsonian Contributions to Knowledge, Feb. 1854, pp. 8, 9. LONG-HORNED DIATOMACEZ. 107 the cup-shaped and hispid character of our Breydon species, but is destitute of the neck. Syndendrium diadema and Di- cladia capreolus are common species; they are found with the other Chetoceri, in various earths, and guano, and appear to be of the same family. They are chiefly distinguished by long styles, proceeding from the rounded end of the frustule, which styles are branched at the end, and are not unfrequently found with a portion of the membrane adhering to them, in which they seem to have been imbedded. Omphalotheca hispida has the appearance of an imperfect frustule, and Mastogonia pre- texta, of a semi-frustule of Goniothecium Rogersit. We venture to give a synopsis of the Chetoceri, adapted to our present imperfect state of knowledge of these singular organisms. CH TOCEROS. Filamentous ; filaments elliptical, fragile, imperfectly siliceous. Frus- tules without strie, united in pairs by the interlacing on each side, of horns proceeding from the frustules, or from a cingulum between the frustules. Horns often of great length, and sometimes spinous, or serrated. § Horns, four on each side. 1. C. Tetracheta, Ehrenb., Kutz., spec. Alg. 138. §§ Horns, two on each side, and proceeding from tubular apertures in the frustules. * Horns filiform. 2. C. Dicheta, Ehrenb., Kutz., spec. Alg. 1388. 3. C. Didymus, Ehrenb., Kutz., spec. Alg. 133. 4. 0.2 Bacillaria, Bailey, Kutz., spec. Alg. 138. 5. C.2 Diploneiis, Bailey, Kutz., spec. Alg. 138. 6. C. Gastridium, Goniothecitum Gastridium, Ehrenb., Kutz., spec. Alg. 23. See Plate VII., figs. 3—8. N.B.—To Ehrenberg’s description should be added, ‘* Cornubus utrinque duobus.” This species clearly belongs to the genus Chcetoceros. Many examples have occurred with the horns perfect. See Plate vii., fig. 7. CO. incurvum, Bailey. Smithsonian Contributions, Feb. 1854, p. 9. Plats VIR tise 9—11 W ate ., figs. 9—11. We have found this species abundant in guano. I g Mr. Tuffen West has detected in guano frustules of a species, belonging to this section, which is new to me, and may perhaps be C. Bacillaria, Bailey. For figures of these frustules see Plate VII., figs. 1, 2. ** Horns spinous, or serrated. 8. C. boreale, Bailey. Smithsonian Contributions, Feb. 1854, p. 8. ; ; Plate VII., figs. 12—15. 9. C. Peruvianum, Brightwell. Frustules hemispherical. Horns pro- ceeding from the centre of the circular end; very stout and long, and beset with short spines, recurved. * T am also able to state, that C. Wighamti and Goniotheciuin his- pidum have lately been gathered in the bay of the Isle of Roa, near Ulverstone. 108 ON THE FILAMENTOUS, LONG-HORNED DIATOMACE, In guano from Callao, occurring in small flakes or patches full of pieces of the. horns, and a few detached frustules, Plate VIL., figs. 16—18. §§§ Horns proceeding from a cingulum or ring, dinaoe the frustules. 10. C. Wighamii, Brightwell. Frustules cup-shaped, with a band round the mouth of the cup, and a neck or bulb, proceeding from the centre Frustules beset with minute short spines, or papilla, in all parts, except the band. Oval, on a front, or end view, the spines appearing as minute specks. Boiled in acid, the filaments break up, and the frustules, in an isolated state, and detached rings, with the horns proceeding from them, are all that can be detected. The rings may readily be distinguished from the frustules seen endwise, as they are open, and without dots; while the frustules, seen endwise, are dotted. In brackish water, near Breydon, Great Yarmouth. Plate VII., figs. 19—36. We have named this species after the discoverer, Mr. Wigham, an excellent practical botanist, indefatigable in the pursuit of his favourite study, and most liberal in his communications to his friends, 11. C. crenatum. All these species are described or figured by Ehren- 12. OC. hispidum. | bere, from frustules found in a fossil, or deposit 13. C. navicula. | state, and appear to belong to this section of the 14. C. barbatum. genus Cheetoceros.* The OC. Wighamti was, as before stated, found near the salt-water estuary, called Breydon, at the point where the rivers Yare and Waveney meet. It occurred in a gathering made from a dirty ditch of brackish water, at the back of a small public-hLouse, called ‘‘' The Burney Arms,” which is marked on the Ordnance maps. ‘The gathering abounded in Campylodiscus elypeus (a species chiefly known before as occurring in fossil earth from Bohemia), and in one or more species of Mastog gloia ; it also contained Bacillaria paradoxa, Amphora salina, Navicula palpe- bralis and tumens, Melosira varians and subflewilis, and the Ulva bullosa (2); and Protococcus heematodes (?) abounded also in it, with which last the Cheetoceros seemed most associated. It was perhaps parasitical on some Algx, and, after being detached, had floated to where it was discovered. This place has been frequently Visited since Mr. Wigham’s decease, and searched in vain, for the Cheetoceros ; although most of the above species * We subjoin a reference to the figures of most of the species above referred to, given in the Plates to Ehrenberg’s Microgeologie. Mastogonia . . pretexta, Plate XIX. 15. Goniothecium . . Rogersii . Plate XVIII. 92. Sy odontella aan 9 Dawegu, om o ) CAaStridiumieee ees eee Sle x5 Sho Ghtclyonmery 5 yo) OEE an navicula ae PR ap ie KO) * hispidum | eeeeee te sere Oe 3 barbatum .. OG: a - . crenatum, Plate XXXIX, 2. 74. Chetoceros . . didymus, ,, XXXV. A. XVIII. 4, and XVII. Xanthiopyxis . . cingulata, ,, XXXIII. XVII. 18. Chetoceros . . diploneiis Aare se oo UNE lic Syndendrium . . diadema, Plate XXXV. A. XVII. 13. Dicladia . . . capreolus, Dh ror ipl PAG eXCVALIUZ SSS Omphalothecea . . hispida . je . . A. TX 4, HEPWORTH, ON THE MICROSCOPE. 109 were met with. In the living species of C. Wighamzi, the endochrome was seen of a ereen colour, and ageregated in the centre of each frustule, in the manner represented in the figures of Encampia zodaicus, in Kutz. Bac., Pl. XXI., fig. 21, and Pritchard’s Infusoria, Pl. XIII, fic. 43. No appearance of “conjugation has been observed, nor have we been able to detect in this, or any other of the species, mentioned in this paper, which have come under our observation, any strix, or markings of that kind. We have detected most of the species above described in guano (chiefly from Callao), and especially in little transpa- rent flakes or patches containing a mass of frustules. C. gastridium, tncurvum, Wighamii, ane Peruvianum are of most frequent occurrence. There can be little doubt that all the guano of the coast of Peru is in like manner pervaded with these organisms, and if so, we ought to look to this locality for living species. C. Wighamii has, as we have already stated, been lately gathered in Monterey Bay, and a careful search would probably bring other species to light. The discovery of a number of specimens of C. boreale in the stomach of a large species of Holothuria, or Sea-Cucumber, should lead to the examination of the stomachs of Sea-Slugs, especially of such as are known to feed on marine Alga, for specimens of this singular and interesting group of Diato- macee. OxserRVATIONS on the Practicat Appiication of the Micro- scope. By J. Herwortn, Esq. THERE are yet some parties in the medical profession who are sceptical as to the utility of the microscope. I have found it occasionally of practical importance ; and perhaps if I mention a few cases, it may not be uninteresting to the medical readers of the ‘ Journal,’ J. M., a young man, aged twenty-three, applied to me, bringing, in a bottle containing some fluid, a lock of hair, and stating that he had vomited it in the night; that he believed it had been in his stomach three months, during most of which he had been under medical treatment for almost con- stant vomiting, and he thought this had been the cause. I examined the hair, and from the fact of the bulb and sheath being complete, I concluded it had not been in the stomach at all, or the gastric fluid would have dissolved these portions of it. I suggested that it might have been thrown into the vessel into which he vomited: that was found to be the case, on inquiry, although he left with an impression that 110 HEPWORTH, ON THE MICROSCOPE. I was mistaken. To my surprise (in so young a man) I found abundance of Sarcina Ventriculi amongst the secretions attached to the hair. I prescribed, and the man got well in three weeks. Had I not accidentally made the discovery, he might have gone on vomiting three or six months longer. J.W., aged twenty-eight, complained of great pain and irrita- tion on micturition, and stated that he passed great quantities of matter. On examining the secretion, I concluded from its appearance, together with the symptoms, that the matter it contained was pus; but with the aid of the microscope I found it to be triple phosphate. I mentioned this case to a friend, a (microscopical) sceptic, who observed that I might have ascertained that by chemical analysis. I admitted it ; but such a tedious process would have taken up too much time ; whereas, with the instrument, I convinced myself of the fact ina few seconds, and was able immediately to give an opinion as to the probable result. I may further state, that the man, although so young, had lost all his upper teeth, and the first step towards his improvement was to procure an efficient set of these necessary articles: this he succeeded in doing (thanks to the dentists), and there was a gradual return to health, which I attribute more to the dentist’s skill than to any other remedy. T. V., a boy five years old, had general anarsarca after scarlatina: there was a brownish deposit in the urine. On examination I found it contained altered blood dises (having the appearance of toothed wheels), triple phosphate, abund- ance of casts of the tubuli uriniferi, and, I thought, a few pus globules (they might be mucous), but no brown epithelial scales, which is a usual accompaniment with casts, as far as I have remarked. The urine coagulated on the addition of nitric acid. These appearances told a tale, which could not have been so fully known without the aid of the micro- scope. I received from a friend a substance stated to be a portion of a concretion passed per anum by a patient at the Man- chester Infirmary: the case was one of Dr. E. Wilkinson’s, who has kindly furnished me with some particulars, a few of which I shall state. R. L., etat fifty-two, a weaver, four years ago began to complain of pain in the stomach and right side; it was so severe at times that he could not retain the erect posture : soon after he perceived a fulness in the side, the tumour gradually increased, and about two years ago GREEN PIGMENT-DEGENERATION OF THE HEART. 111 he, with severe pain, passed a hard, flattened, spherical con- cretion, of a light-brown colour, about two inches in diameter. His diet consisted principally of oatmeal and milk. The tumour still remains, and occupies a large portion of the abdomen. The concretions (of which he has passed several about the same size and character) appear to consist of com- pact masses of the beard of the oat. Mrs. G. brought her son, a boy four years of age, who, she feared, bad got the itch: the eruption appeared suspicious, but did not occupy the usual situations on the body. With a small pair of curved scissors I snipped off a pustule, in which I detected two ovaof the Acarus Scabiei: this settled the matter at once. This leads me to state that I have never seen a good repre- sentation of the mandibles of the Acarus. In a large and beautiful engraving, in the possession of a friend, there is only a slight indication of teeth up the centre of the head, as though the mandibles were single members. Having recently mounted a specimen, which shows the part so well, I have given a drawing (Plate VIII., fig. 3) ; also the mandibles of some other Acaride. A mandible consisting of a single member, appears, so far as my observation goes, to be the ex- ception and not the rule in the Acar?. The mandibles of Acarus of the domestic Fly (fig. 6) appear to be a pair of simple forceps; whilst those of the Water Rat (fig. 14) seem to be a combination of forceps and scissors. ‘There are two Acari of the Mole (which has its peculiar Flea, also), one (fig. 11) with the mandible fur- nished with four barbed hooks, and the other (fig. 12) with only a single hook, similar to that of the rabbit (fig. 13). All the other specimens have double crab-like members. On a Case of Green Picment-DEGENERATION of the Heart. By Dr. Tuupicuum. In March last I gave to the Pathological Society of London an account of a case of green pigment degeneration of the heart, which has been published in the sixth volume of the Transactions of that Society. In a foot-note on p. 141 of the Transactions, I stated that I had since had an opportunity of examining the heart of a man, aged fifty-four, who died of disease of the brain (apoplexy from atheromatous arteries), which presented features analogous to those described in my first observation. 112 CASE OF GREEN PIGMENT- This case I have thought myself justified in recording at full length in this Journal, together with some observations on the present state of the question. The aorta was in a state of atheromatous degeneration, with numerous scales of calcareous deposits, The left ventricle was hypertrophied to an enormous extent, the walls being nearly an inch in thickness. The microscopic examination gave the following result :— The muscular fibres from the outer wall show a granular deposit of a dirty-yellowish colour. The granules are of all sizes and shapes (Plate IX., figs. 1, 2), with a dark outline when well focussed. Their colour is deeper in some parts than in others; in some places it is a pale, dirty-yellowish tint, in others sap-green. The granules are deposited in patches, length-lines, mostly in the axis of the fibre, or singly, scattered about, all apparently inside the sarcolemma, The patches are very often broad and at regular intervals, so that it seems as if they represented transformed nuclei (fig. 2 5), particularly as the nuclei themselves are broad, nearly square, with rounded-off angles (fig. 2a). In some places the deposit is principally conspicuous at both ends of a nucleus (fig. 2). The fibres themselves have preserved their transverse striz ; numerous length-lines run along the fibres parallel with their long axis, and crossing the transverse striz, which thence appear as if they only reached from length-line to length- line (Plate [X., fig. 1). Acetic acid dissolves the fibres, and leaves the nuclei and the unchanged granular deposit conspicuous. Though the muscular fibres have a greenish tinge when lying in thick layers, yet this tinge disappears when they are lying singly, and when acetic acid is added, then all tinge, except that of the green corpuscles, disappears. The septum atriorum showed less deposit in its fibres, which were however more macerated ; its striae were scarcely distinct as such, but gave the fibres an irregularly-shaded granular appearance, like figs. 2, 3. In one of the right trabecule where the fibres are most friable, and break into debris on preparation for microscopic examination, the general tinge is deepest, but the deposit, though consisting of many granules, is not very conspicuous, because the granules are very small. The right ventricle is in a state of atrophy, in every respect the reverse of the left. The walls are thin, flabby, and tear like rags. Their fibres are atrophied, pale, and very friable ; ereat masses of fat-cells, or oil-drops, and globules of all sizes are scattered through their tissue. Smaller fat-drops of the DEGENERATION OF THE HEART. 113 usual bluish-white colour, with the dark outline, are seen inside the sarcolemma along with the fine granular deposit. The fat, or otl-drops, from the largest to the smallest (fig. 3 b), become beautifully conspicuous on addition of acetic acid, and so do the granular-yellowish and green corpuscles (fig. 3 a), which thereby manifest themselves as being a distinct deposit, and not a deposit of fat, as encountered in what is commonly called fatty degeneration (fig. 3). eel specimen boiled in ether showed the solubility of all the fat globules in ether, since the granular-yellowish and green deposit remained unchanged. On the ether cooling and acetic acid being added, oil-globules were precipitated again, ‘They adhered to certain projecting parts, or along the nerve fibres, which had the appearance represented in fig. 5, evidently from the fat of the contents of the fibre having been dissolved and deposited again out of the solution against the walls of the fibre. Before boiling with ether the nerves had the usual appearance represented in fig. 4. This proves that mere boiling with ether is not sufficient to remove all fat, but that subsequent washing with repeated small portions of hot ether is necessary in order to remove all fatty matter. The few drops of ether in which the specimen had been boiled, which were clear when hot, became turbid after cooling, and under the microscope showed myriads of oil- globules of a more equal size, and molecules, of which the globules were being formed. None of the oil-globules depo- sited from the ether were tinged in any way, and the mus- cular fibres retained their greenish tinge after boiling, and preserved unchanged the yellowish or green deposit. This peculiar degeneration of the heart has been observed by Wedl (‘Elements of Pathological Histology’ pp. 171, 227), and by Kolliker, quoted by Wedl. Both call the deposit pigment, on account of its “ dirty-yellowish” colour, What relation there exists between this pigment and “‘ the tapering groups of small, isolated, yellowish granules,” seen at either end of the wrale of the fibres of any healthy heart, as de- scribed by Mr. Paget (‘Surgical Pathology,’ vol. i., p. 128), is a question to be answered by further investigation, The report on my first specimen given to the Pathological Society by Drs. Habershon and Bristowe, and printed at pages 142 and 143 of the ‘ Transactions,’ though admitting the correctness, on the whole, of my description of the micro- scopic appearances, is to the effect that the specimen de- scribed by me does not differ from the ordinary run of cases of fatty degeneration. The reporters did not find the molecular deposit greener than the fibres, and the latter pre- VOL. IV. I 114 CASE OF GREEN PIGMENT- sented so very faint a greenish tinge, that they should have passed it unnoticed, had not their attention been specially directed to it. They believe the molecular deposit to be neither green nor pigment, but simply fat. I believe that this discrepancy with my account may be explained by the follow- ing circumstances. The patient died on March 10th; I made the post mortem examination on March 13th, which was ona Tuesday. From the day following I had the heart under examination in a warm room during four successive days. On Saturday 17th I intended to give an account of the specimen to the Medical Society of London, but was pre- vented from doing so, and on that evening the heart went into the hands of Dr. Routh, who put it in spirits of wine, as it was already decomposing by that time. Happily I had on that day exhibited specimens under the microscope to several friends, all of whom found the molecular deposit to be green, one of them, Dr. A. Henry, so much so, that he deliberated with me, what appropriate name could be given to the deposit. Dr. Gibb recollects to the present moment, that he distinctly saw a green molecular deposit in the specimen submitted by me to his inspection. The artist, who made the diagram which I exhibited to the Pathological Society in illustra- tion of my paper, coloured it after specimens under the micro- scope. The eye of this gentleman is perfectly achromatic, and practised in the minutest distinction of colours. On the other hand, my microscope is equally achromatic. On Tuesday, March the 20th, the specimen was, by the kindness of Dr. Quain, brought before the Pathological Society. Already, on that evening, I could not succeed in showing the green colours under the microscope, because, as I then thought, the light was too yellow and too strong, being con- densed by Gillet’s apparatus. But I now believe that it was mainly due to the colour having been changed by decom- position and extracted by spirits of wine. After the meeting of the Pathological Society, the specimen, with several others, was put into strong spirits of wine, and it was only from the 21st downwards, eight days after the post mortem, that the specimen, in spirits, could be examined by the reporters. I therefore humbly submit that their report was not based upon the original appearances, but upon a specimen changed by the united influences of putrefaction and spirits of wine. On the 24th I gave to Mr. Brooke, of Keppel Street, a mounted specimen for examination. He submitted it to an eminent microscopist, who declared it was nothing which he had not seen before. I requested Mr. Brooke to look at it himself, and he kindly did so in my presence, using per- DEGENERATION OF THE HEART. 115 fectly white light for illumination, Though in many parts the green colours had entirely faded, the specimen being mounted in water, yet Mr. Brooke found clusters of molecular deposit, the colour of which he declared to be green beyond any doubt. He was quite positive about that. Even when he used a second power in the place of an eye-piece, which arrangement affords an exquisitely high magnifying power, and with a careful adjustment affords a beautifully clear view of the object, the colour of the clusters of molecular deposit appeared to him (and to myself) perfectly green. Two days after there was only a vestige of the deep-green colour left; it had decomposed, and dissolved in the fluid surrounding the specimen. I have gone to such length, because, if the report of Drs. Habershon and Bristowe stands unexplained, either my veracity or the correctness of my sight might be doubted, and for either I should be very sorry indeed. But happily there are some witnesses to the green colour of the deposit before it was decomposed, and to this fact my character and that of my eye look for protection. Already, in the note to my paper in the ‘ Transactions’ at the Pathological Society, I have recorded my opinion on that degeneration, the produce of which, said to be fat, does not dissolve in ether. There is no fat, either in the vegetable or animal kingdon which does not dissolve in ether and volatile oils (Lehmann, ‘Theoretical Chemistry,’ 3rd edit, p 273.) It is, therefore, an error to call a deposit fat which does not dissolve in ether. Since I saw green pigment for the first time, I have ex- amined a great number of hearts and found green pigment in three more instances. In one case where the colour was most conspicuous, I was afforded a good opportunity of witnessing how quickly the green colour is changed by decomposition. It was in June; the heart stood for two days on a plate, covered by a saucer; on being uncovered it was found to be in the first stage of putrefaction, viz., smelling badly, covered with greasy matter and exuding brown serum. ‘The green pigment was found to have changed its colour into a dirty earth-brown, and only here and there a faint indication of the former colour could be distinguished. I think it only just to say that my paper was read and the report thereon given, before I was aware or it had been stated that Wedl and Kd6lliker mention a similar deposit. Corro- boration of my observations is accumulating. Rokitansky, at p- 189 of the new (8rd) edition of his ‘ Pathological Anatomy,’ speaks of granular pigment deposited in striated muscular u 2 116 WESTON, ON THE ACTINOPHRYS SOL. fibre, which is undergoing fatty degeneration. At p. 217 he mentions rusty brown granular pigment in muscular fibrils, which have lost their stria, and in the atrophied muscles of a stump after amputation. I hope to resume the subject in some future number of the Microscopical Journal. On the Actinopurys Sot. By J. Weston, Esq., H.E.1.C. Havine during the last two or three months met with a plen- tiful supply of Actinophrys Sol, and fortunately also a most unusual deficiency of professional calls upon my time, I have been enabled to pay these little creatures considerable atten- tion, not, I hope, quite fruitlessly, since the description I am about to give of some of their peculiar habits will, I think, be novel. I would premise, that as my knowledge of the microscope is in its infancy (something less than two years old), my ob- servations will be confined mostly to what I have actually seen and shown to some of my friends, leaving deductions to older hands and abler heads. I regret that I shall have to call in question the correct- ness of descriptions given by previous writers; but as I “pin my faith on no man’s sleeve,” and have rather a method of looking and thinking for myself, I shall fearlessly state what the instrument has revealed, much of which differs so mate- rially from a Paper on the same creature in the lst volume of the Journal, that I am led to imagine the writer and myself have been observing a different species. In the first place, then, as there appears to be doubt about the existence of a valvular opening, I have had some thousands of these animalcules under my observation, and have never met with a specimen where the valve was absent. It is best distinguished when about the edge of the seeming disc, and so far as my observations go, is never still night nor day ; being slowly, but without cessation, as it were, protruded, occupying from ten to seventy or eighty seconds in its development, and then, like the bursting of a vesicle, rapidly and totally sub- siding ; for an instant it has utterly disappeared, only to be again as gradually and as certainly reproduced. Should that side of the creature, where the valve is placed, be turned from the observer, the effects of the contraction are distinctly seen, although the valve itself is not, for at the instant of its burst- WESTON, ON THE ACTINOPHRYS SOL. LF ing and closure, some half-a-dozen or more of the tentacles, situated on or about it, which have been gradually thrust from their normal position by the act of its protrusion, now rapidly approach each other with a jerk-like motion, caused by the sudden bringing together of their bases. With one-eighth of an inch objective I have been led to imagine the valve to be formed of a double layer of the external hyaloid membrane, the edges of which appear io adhere to each other tenaciously, notwithstanding the growing distension from within, until the force becomes so great that the lips, as they may be called, suddenly separate, apparently to give vent to some gaseous product, and at this moment there is, as I have stated, enough seen to induce the belief in the existence of a double lip-like valve, perhaps the organ of respiration. A rough sketch,* Pl. [X., fig. 6 ¢., shows the valve distended. The power employed was two-thirds objective, and No, 2 eye- piece of Smith and Beck. The mode of feeding in the Actinophrys Sol has not, f think, been accurately given, ‘That the tentacles possess some other power than that of mere prehension appears to me evident, because nearly every creature of moderate, and sometimes im- moderate size, which strikes against them, is at once, for a time, rendered immovable; when a Rotifer, in crossing the field with velocity, strikes against an object, the rotatory organ is frequently seen quickly to suspend its operation, the more particularly should its cilia strike the cilia of another ani- malcule ; frequently no notice whatever appears to be taken of the shock, except a sudden change in its course; not so, however, with the victim to the Actinophrys Sol, on the instant of contact with whose tentacles it appears paralyzed. In some cases the prisoner is held for some seconds on the exact spot where it struck, and then, without any visible means, becomes attracted towards the body of the A. Sol, gliding slowly down the tentacle until it is jammed between its base and a neighbouring one. In another instance (in the same creature) instead of the prisoner being arrested on or near the extremity of the tentacle at which it strikes, it is shot down to the base with extreme rapidity, to occupy the same position as in the former case. In a third it would seem as if the appetite of the Actinophrys were sated, or that the prisoner was not approved of, for after remaining stunned, sometimes for a few seconds, four or five, sometimes much longer, ciliary motion (of a Vorticella, for instance) is feebly commenced in- ternally, not with sufficient energy to produce motion, but, as * We are unable to obtain the assistance of an artist here, or the sketches should not have been rough. 118 WESTON, ON THE ACTINOPHRYS SOL. if a return to vitality were being effected by struggles; shortly it is seen to glide off the tentacle (as if this appendage pos- sessed the power both of appropriation and rejection), and frequently, with but little sign of recovered life, it slowly floats out of the field. We have now arrived at the point where the intended food is fixed, the next process is as follows: from the margin of the body of the Actinophrys a thin pellucid membrane is pro- jected, up the side of the creature destined for food, which proceeds rapidly, but almost imperceptibly, to surround one side of it; a similar membrane springs sometimes also from the Actinophrys, but more frequently from the tentacle on its other side; these amalgamate on the outer surface of the prisoner, which is thus enclosed in a sac, composed of what I take to be the extended outer vesicle of the aed; G oe The first family is connected by the typical genus Lagena with the second, and by Hntosolina with the fifth ; the second is united with the third through Marginulina; the third with the fourth through Globigerina ; and the fourth with the last through Uvige- rind. Whether these singular and little-known animals are Rhizopodes, or belong to the Ameeba, remains yet to be satisfactorily made out. London, June 18, 1855. 760% ZOOPHYTOLOGY. Tue species of Polyzoa here described, and most of which appear to be new, occurred on shells fan Mazatlan, on the Gulf of California ; and for the opportunity of examining them, I have been indebted to the kindness of Mr. Phillip Carpenter, who has prepared a descriptive catalogue of the “* Mazatlan Mollusca,” for the British Museum. The typical specimens of the forms here noticed, will be found in that Institution. Order. PoLyzoA INFUNDIBULATA. Sub-order I, CHEmLostomata. Fam, MermBRANIPORIDA. Gen. 1. Membranipora, Blainv. 1, M. denticulata (n. sp.), Busk. Pl. VII., figs. 1 and 2 Area of cells rhomboidal ; internal margin of the aperture denticulate ; cells separated by a narrow raised line. Hab. Mazatlan: on the shells of Imperator olivaceus, I. unguis, and Anomia. The outline of inh! cells is usually distinctly defined by a narrow brown line. One or two rounded or triangular emi- nences (probably ovicells) are visible on many of the cella front and below. The form bears considerable resemblance to M. Savartii, (Savigny, Egypt, pl. 10; M. Lacroizii, Savigny, B. M. fore , p. 60, Plate 104, fig. 1 ,) but differs from it in several impor cand respects ; among which may be noticed a narrow brown line surrounding the cells, and clearly defining one from the other; and the irregularly shaped branching denticles with which the margin of the internal aperture is furnished. 2. M. gothica, n. sp.. Rylands, MS. Pl. VIL., fig. 5, 6, 7. Area of cells elongated, oval; margin thin and smooth; mouth raised, suborbicular, with an ovide notch inferiorly; the anterior, calcareous, depressed surface of the cells punctated, and perforated on each side by a wide aperture; large, immersed avicularia scattered irregularly over the polyzoary. Hab. Mazatlan: on Imperator olivaceus and unguis. There is occasionally a short blunt spine or process on each side of the mouth, a character which is also presented in M. Rozieri, Savig. (B. M. Cat., p. 59, Plate 65, fig. 6) a species to which the present exhibits, in other respects, con- siderable resemblance, and especially in the existence of the large opening on sod side of the front of the cells immedi- ately below the mouth. The differences between the two, however, are sufficiently striking. In M. Rozieri the ovicell ZOOPHYTOLOGY. 177 is large, superior, rounded, and carinate in front, whilst in I. gothica, as in M. calpensis, Busk. B. M. Cat., p. 60, Plate 104, fig. 5, 6, this organ appears to be represented by one or two rounded eminences at the bottom of the cell in front. The large scattered avicularia also are characteristic of the present form, as well as its far larger size. The same species occurs on a Pearl-oyster shell, for which I am indebted to Dr. J. E. Gray, the habitat of which seems to be doubtful. In M. Milne Edward’s Memoir “Sur les Eschares,” p. 17, Plate 12, fig. 13, a miocene fossil is described and figured, which bears some resemblance to the present; it differs principally, so far as can be determined from the figure alone, in the thickened and granulated margin of the area. 3. WM. aH. spor El. Vil. fig. 3,4 Apparently an undescribed form, but requiring further research for its precise determination. Hab. As the preceding. Gen, 2. Lepralia, Johnston. 1. L. marginipora, Reuss. Fossil. Polyp. d. Wiener tertiar. Becken., py Co: Pl Oh fies 231) Busk he. . p. 4. Cells ovate, convex or slightly depressed, immersed, roughish, punctate at the margin; mouth round, or subelliptical; margin thickened, with an avicularium on each side. Hab. Mazatlan: on Imperator unguis ; Vienna tertiary basin (fossil) ? As the form appears precisely to resemble the tertiary species described and figured by Reuss, I have applied his name to it, and in great part employed his character. 2. L. humilis, n. sp. Busk,1l.c., p. 5. Pl. VIIL., fig. 1. Cells immersed, depressed, or flattened, surface obscurely punctate ; mouth small, rounded, with a shallow sinus in the lower lip, margin simple, thin. Hab. Mazatlan: on Imperator unguis. 3. L. hippocrepis, n. sp. Busk, l.c., p. 4. Pl. VIIL, fig. 2. Cells immersed, punctate ; mouth suborbicular or elliptical, its wpper margin in the older cells inconspicuous, inferiorly and laterally, thickened with an avicularium on each side. Hab, Mazatlan: on Imperator olivaceus. The peculiar horse-shoe shaped mouth of the older cells, with the avicularia on either side, sufficiently distinguishes the present from L. marginipora, to which, in the mouth of the younger cells, it bears some resemblance. 4. L. Mazatlanica, n, sp. Busk, 1. ¢., p. 3. Pl. VIIL, fig. 4. Cells immersed, depressed, or ventricose; surface punctate; mouth VOL. IV. N 178 ZOOPHYTOLOGY. suborbicular, with a wide simus in the lower lip; margin thickened, raised ; a single avicularium (more rarely two) on the side near the mouth. Hab. Mazatlan: on Imp. olivaceus and unguis. This form might easily be confounded with some varieties of L. unicornis, or L. Ballii (B. M. Cat.) It is distinguished, however, by its reddish colour, and the raised mouth, together with its thickened margin. The single, or sometimes double avicularium, points outwards and upwards, and the mandible is prolonged and acute. This organ is sometimes, but not often absent. 5. L. adpressa, Busk. (B. M. Cat., p. 82. Pl. CII., fig. 8, 4.) Hab. Mazatlan: on Columbella major, C. fuscata, and Pisania gemmata, not uncommon. Chiloe, 96, fm. Shell ; Darwin. The Mazatlan form differs from that from which the former description and figure were taken, in the absence, or indis- tinctness rather, of the radiating grooves. In other respects the two agree very closely. 6. L. atrofusca, Rylands, MS. Cells elongated, ovate or rhomboidal, bordered with a thin elevated line, surface punctate ; mouth suborbicular, sinuated in the lower lip, toothed on each side. Hab. Mazatlan: on Jmper. olivaceus and unguwis, and on Anomia. General hue blackish ; and even when the cells are more calcareous, and on that account whiter, the dark interstitial line remains very evident. It is quite distinct from L. cucul- lata (B. M. Cat., p. 81, Plate 96, fig. 4, 5) which is also of a black colour, and occurs in the Mediterranean. 7. L. trispinosa, Johnston. (B. M. Cat., p. 70. Pl. 85, fig. 1, 2. P37, ap. ep Hab. Mazatlan: on Imperator ? Britain. A single minute specimen only occurred, but this is quite undistinguishable from the British form. 8. L. rostrata, nu. sp. Busk, |. ¢., p. 4. Cells immersed, surface tuberculous or granulous ; mouth immersed, upper margin inconspicuous ; lower lip deeply grooved, armed with a large sessile avicularium, Hab. Mazatlan: on Jmp. unguis. The lower margin of the mouth, in the mature cells, is deeply grooved in the middle; and on one side of the groove is a strong, short, blunt spinous process; and on the other a comparatively large, raised avicularium, which looks towards the sulcus, and whose mandible is acute, and points upwards and outwards. The surface of the cell is often beset with short raised spines or processes ; and these projecting over the ZOOPHYTOLOGY. 179 mouth of the cell beneath, give it the appearance of being furnished with several oval spines. Gen. 3. Cellepora, O. Fabricius. 1. OC. papilleformis, n. sp., Busk, |. c., p.5. Pl. VIII, fig. 5. Cells sub-hexagonal, raised, surface punctate ; mouth suborbicular, with a tooth on each side, margin simple, thin; scattered avicularia, with a triangular mandible. Hab. Mazatlan: on Imp. olivaceus. A well-marked and distinct form belonging to that sub- division of Cellepora in which the mouth is not armed with a projecting avicularium. The top of each cell projects in the form of a rounded mamillary eminence from a hexagonal area, which defines the border of the cell. The cells are of very unequal size, and very irregularly disposed. It is of a brownish colour. 2. C. cyclostoma, n. sp., Busk, 1. c., p. 5. Pl. VIII, fig. 3. a, b, ¢. Cells suberect or decumbent, discrete ; surface punctate; mouth large, rounded above, with a wide sinus in the lower lip; the margin in the older cells much raised, thickened, occasionally dilated, infundibuliform, and furnished with a minute avicularium on each side. Hab. Mazatlan: on Imp. unguis. The wide, rounded, or elliptical, raised margin of the mouths of the distant cells, gives the polyzoarium of the present species a very peculiar and well-marked aspect. It is of a brownish hue or white. Sub-order Il, CycLosTroMaTa. Fam. Discoporap&, Busk, MS. Gen. Defrancia, Brown. 1. D. intricata, n. s., Busk, |. ¢., p. 6. Dise very irregular in form, rows of cells radiating irregularly ; orifices of cells and intersticial pores of equal size, Hab. Mazatlan: on Jmperator unguis, The small irregular patches appear to be constituted by the confluence of several sets of cost@, with their corresponding interstices, each set radiating from a depressed central point. It differs from D. deformis, Reuss (op. cit. p. 36, Plate 5, fig. 24), in the uniform size of the openings of the tubes in the costa, and of the pores in the interstices. Besides the above, there occur on some of the shells in the same collection, indications of other species, but in too im- perfect a condition to allow of their determination with any certainty. Among these, perhaps the best marked are a species strongly resembling Cellepora pumicosa, Linn., a species of Lepralia, and a Tubulipora. ZOOPHYTOLOGY. DESCRIPTION OF FIGURES. Puate VII. Fig. 1, 2.—Membranipora denticulata. 38, 4.—Membranipora sp. ? 5, 6, 7.—M. gothica. 8.—Lepralia marginipora. Puate VIII. 1.—Lepralia humilis. 2.—L. hippocrepis. 3.—Cellepora cyclostoma. 4,—L. Mazatlanica. 5.—Cellepora papilleeformis. 6.—L. adpressa. (a8 0" ORIGINAL COMMUNICATIONS. | Further Opservations on the Structure of APPENDICULARIA Frasettum (Chamisso). By T. H. Huxtey, F.RS. (Plate X.) In a paper read before the Royal Society in 1851, I gave an account of a very singular animal which had been frequently observed and described under various names, as Appendicu- laria (Chamisso), Oihopleura (Mertens), Fritillaria (Quoy and Gaimard), Vezillaria (J. Miiller), and Eurycercus (Busch), but whose precise place in the animal kingdom was still a matter of doubt. The essential points in that account will be found in the following extracts :—* * * * * “The animal has an ovoid or flask-like body one-sixth to one-fourth of an inch in length, to which is attached a long curved lanceolate appendage or tail, by whose powerful vibratory motions it is rapidly,propelled through the water. ”’ “* The smaller extremity of the animal is perforated by a wide aperture (d) which leads into a chamber, which occupies the greater part of the body, and at the bottom of this chamber is the mouth. The chamber answers to the respiratory cavity of the Zwnicata, and is lined by an inner tunic distinct from the outer; the space between these, as in the Salpe, being occupied by the sinus system. ‘On the side to which the caudal appendage is attached, an endostyle (c), altogether similar to that of the Salpe, lies between the inner and outer tunics; and opposite to this, or on the ventral side, close to the respiratory aperture, there is a nervous ganglion, to which is attached a very distinct spherical auditory sac, containing a single, also spherical, otolithe. The sac is about 1-200th of an inch in diameter. The otolithe about 1-800th, figs. 1, 2, 4 a. “« Anteriorly, a nerve is given off from the ganglion (a) which becomes lost about the parietes of the respiratory aperture; another large trunk passes backwards (0) over the left side of the cesophagus, and between the lobes of the stomach, until it reaches the appendage, along the axis of which it runs, giving off filaments in its course, fig. 2.” «« There is no proper branchia; but that organ seems to be represented by a richly-ciliated band or fold (e) of the inner tunic, which extends from the opening of the mouth forwards, along the ventral surface of the respiratory cavity, to nearly as far as the ganglion; when it divides into two branches, one of which passes up on each side, so as to encircle the cavity (f). This circlet evidently represents the ‘ ciliated band’ of Salpa. The mouth (g)is wide, and situated at the posterior part of the ventral parietes of the respiratory chamber. The cesophagus (/) short, and slightly curved, opens into a wide stomach (7) curved transversely, so as to present two lobes posteriorly. * Nova Acta Acad. Curiosorum, t. xi. pars secunda, pp. 313 and 314, VOL. IV. O 182 HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. “< Between the two lobes, posteriorly, the intestine (/) commences, and passing upwards (or forwards) terminates on the dorsal surface just in front of the insertion of the caudal appendage (/). “ The heart lies behind, between the lobes of the stomach. I saw no corpuscles, and the incessant jerking motion of the attached end of the caudal appendage rendered it very difficult to make quite sure even of the heart’s existence.” «‘ The caudal appendage (A) is attached or rather inserted into the body on the dorsal surface just behind the anus. It consists of a long, appa- rently structureless, transparent, central axis (m), rounded at the attached, and pointed at the free end. This axis is enveloped in a layer (0) of lon- gitudinal, striped, muscular fibres; which form the chief substance, in addition to a layer of polygonal epithelium cells, of the broad alary expan- sion on each side of the axis.” ““The only unequivocal generative organ I found in Appendicularia was a testis (p), consisting of a mass of cells developed behind and below the stomach, enlarging so much in full-grown specimens as to press this completely out of place. ‘In young specimens the testis is greenish, and contains nothing but small pale circular cells; but in adults it assumes a deep orange red- colour, caused by presence of multitudes of spermatozoa, whose develop- ment from the circular cells may be readily traced. «This orange-red mass, or rather masses, for there are two in juxta- position, is described by Mrrrens as the ‘ Samen-behalter’ or vesicula seminales. He describes them as making their exit, bodily, from the animal, and then becoming diffused in the surrounding water. This cir- cumstance, indeed, appears to have furnished his principal reason for . believing these bodies to be what the name indicates. «The spermatozoa have elongated and pointed heads about 1-500th of an inch in length, and excessively long and delicate filiform tails. ‘© MprTENs describes as an ovary, two granulous masses, which he says lie close to the vesiculz seminales, and have two ducts, which unite and open into this ‘ ovisac.’ «This appears to me to be nothing more than the granulous greenish mass of cells and undeveloped spermatozoa, which exists in the testis at the same time as the orange-red mass of fully-developed spermatozoa. “ T saw nothing of any ducts, nor do I know what the ‘ ovisac’ can be, unless it be a further development of an organ which I found in two specimens (fig. 3 q), consisting of two oval finely-granulous masses, about 1-300th of an inch in diameter, attached, one on each side of the middle line, to the dorsal parietes of the respiratory cavity, and projecting freely into it.” “‘ Still less am I able to give any explanation of the extraordinary en- velope or ‘ House’ to which, according to MErTENS,* each Appendicularia is attached in its normal condition. I have seen many hundred specimens of this animal, and have never observed any trace of this structure ; and I have had them in vessels for some hours, but this organ has never been developed, although Mrrrens assures us that it is frequently re-formed, after being lost, in half an hour, “ At the same time it is quite impossible to imagine, that an account so elaborate and detailed, can be otherwise than fundamentally true, and therefore, as MERTENS’ paper is not very accessible, I will add his * J have given this passage at length in order that others may be led to seek its explanation. Leuckart and Gegenbaur have been as unsuccessful as myself in finding any such structure; but that it should be purely imaginary seems past belief. HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. 183 account of the matter, trusting that further researches may clear up the point. ** The formation of the envelope or ‘ Haus’ commences by the develop- ment of a lamina from the ‘ semicylindrical organ’ (ganglion ?). This, as it grows, protrudes through the opening at the apex of the animal (respi- ratory aperture). Its corners then become bent backwards and inwards, and thus a sort of horn is formed on each side, the small end of which is turned towards the apex of the animal, while its mouth looks backwards, downwards and outwards. “ At the same time two other horns are developed upwards (the animal is supposed to have its small end downwards), one on each side. ‘These are smaller and more convoluted than the others. “This four-horned structure consists of a very regular network of vessels, in which, at the time of the development of the organ, a very evident circulation is visible; the blood-corpuscles streaming from the attached end of the organ. ‘ The clearness with which the circulation was perceptible, together with the great abundance of vessels and the large extent over which they were spread, were circumstances which led me (says Mertens) to believe this truly enigmatical structure to be an organ, whose function was the decarbonization of the blood. The ease with which the animal becomes separated from this organ is no objection to this view ; the necessity there seems to exist for the reproduction of the latter rather confirming my opinion.’ “It is highly desirable that more information should be gained about this extraordinary respiratory organ, which, if it exist, will not only be quite swz generis in its class, but in all animated nature. And in a phy- siological point of view, the development of a vascular network, many times larger than the animal from which it proceeds, in the course of half an hour, will be a fact equally unique and startling.” “ For my own part, I think there can be no doubt that the animal is one of the Tunicata. The whole organization of the creature, its wide respiratory sac, its nervous system, its endostyle, all lead to this view. “In two circumstances, however, it differs widely from Tunicata hitherto known. The first of them is, that there is only one aperture, the respiratory, the anus opening on the dorsum ; and secondly that there is a long caudal appendage. ““ As to the first difference, it may be observed, that, in the genus Pelonaia,* an undoubted Ascidian, there are indeed two apertures, but there is no separation into respiratory and cloacal chambers. Suppose that in Pelonaia the cloacal aperture ceased to exist, and that the rectum, instead of bending down to the ventral side of the animal, continued in its first direction and opened externally, we should have such an arrangement as exists in Appendicularia. “‘ With regard to the second difference, I would remark, that it is just the existence of this caudal appendage which makes this form so exceedingly interesting. *“Tt has been long known that all the Ascidians commence their ex- istence as larvee, swimming freely by the aid of a long caudate appendage ; and as in all great natural groups some forms are found which typify, in their adult condition, the larval state of the higher forms of the group, so * I would particularly remark that the statement that there is no separation between the branchial and cloacal chambers in Pelonaia is erroneous. At the time this paper was written I had not examined Pelonaia (whose structure, as I have since found, differs in no essential point from that of an ordinary Cynthia), and I must have misunderstood the verbal information given by my lamented friend Professor E. Forbes. o 2 184 HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. does Appendicularia typify, in its adult form, the larval state of the Ascidians. “ Appendicularia, then, may be considered to be the lowest form of the Tunicata ; connected, on the one hand, with the Salpe, and on the other with Pelonaia, it forms another member of the hypothetical group so remarkably and prophetically indicated by Mr. MacLeay, and serves to complete the circle of the Tunicata. In 1854 Dr. Rudolph Leuckart published, among many other valuable contributions to zoological science, a memoir on Appendicularia (for a copy of which I am indebted to the courtesy of the Author.)* In several points Dr. Leuckart’s view of Appendicularia differs from my own. 1. With regard to the “oval finely-granulous masses’’ at- tached on each side of the dorsal parietes, Leuckart states that they are by me considered to be ‘ probably the ovaries.” My words, it will be observed, hardly justify this assertion ; I merely stated that they seem to be a further development of what Mertens calls the ovisac, which is a very different propo- sition. Dr. Leuckart’s own view of these bodies, “that they are the earliest indications of the subsequently-formed stig- mata,” p. 84, is one with which I am, like Gegenbaur, unable to agree. In fact, as will subsequently appear, Dr. Leuckart has overlooked the true branchial apertures, unless indeed what he describes as the anus be one of them, The anal aperture, he states, is “‘ situated on the right side, near the middle line, and exhibits a strong ciliary movement.” Now, the anus is really in the middle line, and the ciliary movement which it exhibits could hardly be thus characterized, but, as will be seen below, the description would perfectly apply to one of the branchial apertures. 2. Dr. Leuckart failed to discover spermatozoa in the organ which is described by me as a testis. Nevertheless, it will be shown by-and-by that there can be no doubt that such is its real nature. 3. Finally, Dr. Leuckart arrives at the conclusion that Ap- pendicularia is a larval form, and not, as I had suggested, an adult animal. In 1855 Dr. Carl Gegenbaur, a very careful and excellent observer, published a memoir t on Appendicularia, containing the results of more extensive investigations than had hitherto been made. Adopting the view that Appendicularia is an adult form, Dr. Gegenbaur constitutes four species of the * Zoologische Untersuchungen von Dr. Rudolf Leuckart, Heft. II. Salpen und Verwandte. + Bemerkungen ueber die organization des Appendicularen, Siebold und K6lliker’s Zeitsch, B. VI. AUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. 185 genus, A. furcata, A. acrocerca, A. cophocerca, and A. ceru- lescens. The most important and novel point in Dr. Gegen- baur’s paper, however, is the discovery and description of the true branchial apertures, which had been overlooked by all previous observers, Dr. Leuckart and myself included. Dr. Gegenbaur says (I. c., p. 415)— ‘* Tf now we return to the branchial sac, the most remarkable objects are the two respiratory clefts which lie on its ventral wall and partially em- brace the entrance into the esophagus. Hitherto, none of those who have investigated the Appendicularic have recognised the true import of these organs, although Mertens saw them in Ozkoplewra Chamissonis, and Busch (in Hurycerus pallidus) would, in all probability, have understood them had he only borne in mind the typical structure of the Ascidians. Neither Huxley nor Leuckart have mentioned these respiratory aper- tures.” After describing the apertures, Gegenbaur proceeds— “Exact observation shows that they are not simple apertures in th® branchial sac like those of the Ascidians, connecting its cavity with th® surrounding space; but that each is prolonged into a short tube which converges more or less towards its fellow on the ventral face.” In A. furcata these two tubes run ** At first parallel with one another downwards (if the animal be sup- posed to have its anterior part directed upwards, as in the figures), then form a knee-like curve inwards, running directly towards one another, and then entirely vanish, so that nothing more could be made out as to their mode of termination. The function of the respiratory apertures is therefore, in this case, entirely different from that which they perform in the Ascidians, in which the water passes through the branchial clefts, and, after aérating the blood contained in the network of the branchial vessels, collects in the space between the mantle and the branchial sac, to be eventually poured out of the cloacal aperture; while in our Appendicularice the water is led back by tubular prolongations of the branchial clefts into the body, so as either to become directly mixed with the blood, or by some further ramifications of the tubes to act through their thin walls on the surrounding blood. Which of these possibilities really occurs must remain, for the present, undecided; for although in A. cophocerca the end of the respiratory tube may be seen very clearly, yet it is still uncertain whether a bent prolongation of it may not be continued from this point, and may not, by presenting a transverse sectional view, give rise to the appearance of an end. I will enter no further in this place into the discussion of possibilities, my principal object being the statement of facts. However, I believe I have demon- strated that there is a tolerably-marked difference between the respiratory system of the Ascidians and that of the Appendicularice, expressed mor- phologically by the tube proceeding from the respiratory apertures of the latter.” Excessively puzzled to understand how structures so well marked and so obvious as these should have escaped my notice, I was, as may be imagined, very desirous to re-examine Appendicularia ; but although its occurrence in the British 186 HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. Isles was already recorded,* I hardly hoped to find it at acces- sible distances from the shore. During a few calm days last autumn, however, the water of the Bristol Channel, near Tenby, in Caermarthenshire, swarmed with Appendicularie (in company with annelide and crustacean larve, Sagitta, echinoderm larve, Meduse, and Noctiluce); very little dif- ferent from the southern species which I had previously described, and I gladly seized the opportunity of repeating my observations. The length of the body of different specimens varied very much; from one-fifth of an inch to a fifth or sixth that size. The caudal appendage was three or four times as long as the body, broad, flattened, and rounded at its extremity. The whole animal was usually colourless, except that the stomach had a brownish hue. In one instance, however, the caudal appendage was stained of a bright crimson colour, from what cause I know not. With regard to the internal anatomy of the animal, I have, in the main, to confirm the statements I originally made, The oral aperture appeared to be more distinctly bilabiate than I had observed it to be in the southern species, the upper lip hanging over the aperture, and being, as it were, enclosed by the concave edge of the lower. The test forms a thick coat upon all parts of the body, except the posterior region, over the testis, where it is excessively thin. It often separates from the outer tunic in a very curious manner, be- coming thrown into folds and sacculations ; and I was almost inclined to seek here for Mertens’ “Haus,” had not his account been so circumstantially different. The distance between the walls of the pharynx and the outer tunic appeared to be considerably greater than in previously-observed specimens, on the neural side, so that the blood-sinuses were here very large, becoming still wider near the ganglion, in consequence of the outer tunic being raised at this point into a transversely-convex protuberance, gradually diminishing towards the sides of the body. The pharynx is richly ciliated, and narrows posteriorly, its wall nearly follow- ing the contour of the stomach, so that it assumes the shape of a cornucopia, its tapering hinder portion bending up to terminate in the right division of the stomach. With regard to the endostyle, I have nothing important to add to my pre- vious account, except that I believe it to be here, as in other Ascidians, the optical expression of the thickened bottom of a fold or groove of the branchial sac. The large apertures de- * On the coast of Scotland. See Forbes and Hanley, ‘ British Mol- lusea,” vol. iv. p. 247. HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. 187 scribed by Gegenbaur (c), at once strike the eye, not only from their size, but from the vehement action of the long cilia with which they are provided. I can in no way account for haying overlooked them, and I see nothing for it but to accept the fact of the omission as a practical lesson in scientific charity. The pharynx passes on each side into a funnel-like prolonga- tion (b, c), with its apex directed towards one side of the rectum. The dilated base of this prolongation is continuous with the pha- rynx, its comparatively narrow apex opens externally beside the rectum. In the mid-length of this conical canal is a thick- ened circular band (d), formed towards the pharynx of a series of cellaform bodies, placed in a single series, end to end, and externally to this of a transversely-banded substance. It is from this latter portion that the cilia take their origin. They are arranged in several tiers, are very long, and have a strong Wavy motion, That we have here a direct communication between the pharynx and the exterior, and not, as Gegenbaur states, a communication between the pharynx and certain internal canals, was made clear to me, not only by direct observation of the external apertures, but by feeding the animals with indigo. In two specimens this experiment succeeded per- fectly ; but it was very curious, that while in the one the current set zz at the mouth and out at the apertures, in the other the current was in precisely the opposite direction, zn at the apertures and out at the mouth. The wide stomach is bent backwards upon itself, so that its two halves or lobes are pretty nearly parallel, leaving, however, an interval in which the heart is situated. The right lobe is quadrate in outline, and undivided, but the left is irregular and lobulated. ‘The inner surface of the stomach is papillose and ciliated, and many yellowish granules are scattered through the substance of its walls. The intestine arises from the upper angle of its left lobe, bends to the right, and then, when it reaches the middle line, passes forward to the anal aperture. The rectum is ciliated, and, as before, I was unable to find any trace of the tubular “ hepatic’? system, so general among the other Ascidians. The heart (0) is large, and occupies a transverse position be- tween the two lobes of the stomach, laterally, being more closely in contact with the right lobe, and the testis and base of the caudal appendage, antero-posteriorly. I was unable to observe any blood corpuscles, nor could I discover any sign of that reversal of the direction of the contractions so general among the other Ascidians. . The absence of corpuscles would have rendered it almost impossible, under ordinary circum- 188 HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. stances, to discover the direction of the circulating currents, but in one individual, the testis, having attained its full deve- lopment, had broken up within the body, and the sinuses were filled with dark masses of spermatozoa. The heart, in full action, propelled these in a regular course up one side of the caudal appendage and down on the other (Muller has already described such a current in his ‘ Vezillaria’), forwards on the hemal side, and backwards to the heart on the neural side. This individual was particularly instructive also, by affording corroborative evidence as to the nature of the pharyngeal canals. Had these been in any way connected with the sinus system, as Gegenbaur supposes, the sperma- tozoa could hardly have failed to pass into them. Nothing of the sort occurred however; they passed round in the sinus between the walls of these canals and the outer tunic without the slightest extravasation, and their dark hue gave the con- tour of the canals only a better definition than it had before. The testis was always present; small, discoid, and appa- rently attached by minute radiating filaments to the parietes in the younger specimens, it assumed the bilobed form in the larger ones, occupying a large space behind the alimentary canal. Individuals with fully-developed spermatozoa were comparatively rare. In that just referred to, the spermatozoa had rod-like heads, about 1-7000th of an inch long, with very long, delicate, and filiform tails; and the testis was re- duced to a mere transverse band, the greater part of its substance having apparently been shed in the form of sper- matozoa. Of a vas deferens I could find no trace. The rounded bodies (m) on each side of the branchial cavity anteriorly, appeared sometimes to present an internal clear cavity, and might then be easily mistaken for ova. But the absence of any germinal spot, the uniformity in appearance of their bodies, in all individuals hitherto examined, and their position, are very great objections in the way of any such view of the matter, I must confess that the evidence adduced by Gegenbaur appears to me insufficient to prove that the bodies which he describes in other Appendicularie as ovaria are such organs, and for the present I think it is safest to conclude that the female organs of Appendicularia are unknown. With regard to the nervous system and the organs of sense, the only additional observations of importance refer in the first place to the caudal nerve, upon which I found at regular intervals small ganglion-like enlargements (PI. X., fig. 4), from which, as well as in their intervals, minute filaments were given off to the adjacent parts. The largest of these ganglia HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. 189 is the lowest, and when the appendage and the body are parallel, it is about opposite the end of the rectum, The nerve here receives a coat of minute rounded corpuscles, so that an oval mass, about 1-300th of an inch long, is formed, from whence numerous minute fibrils radiate. The other ganglia contain not more than two to five such corpuscles. Gegenbaur states that if Appendicularia furcata be exa- mined from the dorsal surface, an S-shaped cleft, ciliated at its edges, will be observed to the right of the ganglion. The cleft, which occurs only in this species, pierces the wall of the branchial cavity, and puts it in communication with the sinus system. Seeking for this “cleft” in my Appendicularia (flabellum— cophocerca?), 1 came upon a slightly different, but I have no doubt, corresponding organ. This is a pyriform sac (q), about 1-800th of an inch in length, presenting at its wider end an aperture with a produced lip, communicating with the branchial cavity, and by its narrower extremity abutting upon the ganglion. The sac was richly ciliated within, and I have no doubt whatever that it is the homologue of that ‘ciliated sac,” whose existence under different forms appears to be universal among the Ascidians, ‘There is every reason, however, to regard this as an organ of sense, and it never communicates with the sinus-system, so that probably Gegenbaur’s statement may be regarded as an error of inter- pretation. I could discover no transverse muscles in the caudal appendage, but only an upper and a lower layer of longi- tudinal fibres, between which the axis of the tail was enclosed. Whether this central axis is a solid body, or a membranous capsule filled with fluid, I cannot say, but it is assuredly closed at both ends. Its closed and rounded proximal ex- tremity is readily seen, and I feel confident that there is no such communication between the heart and the interior of the axis as Gegenbaur supposes. In the individual already referred to, in which the spermatozoa were effused into the general current of the blood, none entered the axis of the caudal appendage. The discovery of the external openings of the pharyngeal canal and of the true nature of the supposed ‘ciliated cleft,” appears to me to possess peculiar interest, in that it eliminates those structural peculiarities hitherto supposed to exist in Appendicularia, which were in discordance with the general plan of the Ascidians. That an Ascidian should have apertures in its pharynx, establishing a communication between its cavity and the sinus system, would be a great 190 HUXLEY, ON APPENDICULARIA FLABELLUM. anomaly ; but that Appendicularia, being an Ascidian, should possess a ciliated sac, and that the wall of its pharynx should possess ciliated apertures or stigmata, establishing a communication between its cavity and the exterior, inde- pendent of the mouth, is only a strengthening of the evidence of its truly Ascidian nature. Again, while the existence of these apertures establishes further most interesting relations of representation between Appendicularia and the larve of Ascidians, especially of Phallusia, it cuts away all ground for any supposed relations of affinity between the two. In Phallusia, it is true, as Krohn has shown, the cloaca is at first double, and each half, which might be regarded as the equivalent of the outer half of the pharyngeal canal in Appendicularia, opens by an inde- pendent aperture; but then the anus, instead of opening externally, terminates in one of these cavities. The enor- mous size, coarse cillation, and very small number of the pharyngeal stigmata in Appendiculuria, too, are wholly unlike anything larval. The development of the nervous system and of the organs of sense is quite opposed to the supposition that Appendicu- laria is a larval form; and, in answer to Leuckart’s suggestion that developed spermatozoa and ova are found in insect larvae, I would urge that, in these matters, it is hardly safe to judge of one class by analogical arguments drawn from another. I am not aware that such early development of the reproductive products has ever been observed m any mollusk. 3 The discovery of the true branchial apertures in Appen- dicularia appears to me to bear no less importantly upon the moot question of the homologis of the Tunicata and Polyzoa, by removing all doubt as to the truly pharyngeal nature of the branchial sac in the Ascidians. But, if it be a pharynx, it cannot be the homologue of the conjoined tentacles of the Polyzoa, which are entirely pre-pharyngeal structures. Whatever may be the result of future inquiries as to the arrangement of the female organs in Appendicularia, 1 can- not doubt that in A. flabellum we have an adult form in a male state. Whether the female has a totally distinct form, or whether the ova are developed in the same form at a subsequent period (I have observed individuals so young that it is hardly conceivable that the ova should be developed: at an earlier period), is a problem of very great interest, but for whose solution I see no materials at present. Considering thé abundance in which Appendicularia occurs on our own shores, the collection of the requisite data ought to present no HUXLEY, ON THE CHEILOSTOME POLYZOA. 191 great difficulties to those who possess leisure and the oppor- tunities of a sea-side residence; and to any such person, whose eye may fall upon these pages, I commend the investi- gation as one which will amply reward him. Note on the Repropuctive Oreans of the CHEILOsTOME Potyzoa. By T. H. Huxtey, F.RS. Osviows as are the ovicells and partially-developed ova of the cheilostome Polyzoa, the precise position of their ovaria and testis has not yet been determined ; the general idea that the ova are developed within the ovicells being wholly an assumption. ‘The investigation of the question is not without difficulty, on account of the delicacy of the ova in their young condition, the greater or less opacity of the ectocyst, and the obstruction offered by the other viscera if the cells be viewed in any of the positions which they ordinarily assume, lying, that is, on their front or back faces. By tearing up a polyzoarium, with needles, into single series of cells, and causing one of these series to lie upon its side, I found the process of examination much facilitated, In the younger cells of Bugula avicularis, I find that, as in many of the hippocrepian Polyzoa, there is a cord, or funiculus, connecting the extremity of the stomach with the bottom of the cell, and attached to this I found, close to the stomach, a single small pale ovum, commonly possessing a double germinal spot. At its lower attachment, on the other hand, the funiculus is surrounded by a mass of minute, pale, spherical corpuscles. In these cells, no ovicells were as yet developed ; but in older cells they make their appearance as diverticula of the ectocyst and endocyst, having their internal cavity continuous by a narrow neck with that of the cell. A valvular aperture eventually becomes developed at the lower part of their anterior face. In such older cells, the ovicell is at first empty, and we find the ovum attached to the funiculus increasing in size, and acquiring a reddish coloration; but in those still further advanced, a similar, but larger and redder, body makes its appearance in the ovicell, and after undergoing yelk-division becomes a ciliated embryo. In these older cells, again, we find the granular mass at the bottom of the cell gradually developing into a mass of spermatozoa, which eventually float loose in the cavity of the cell. I have no doubt, therefore, that in Bugula avicularis the ovarium is situated at the top of the funiculus, the testis at 192 CURREY, ON REPRODUCTIVE ORGANS OF FUNGI. its base; that impregnation takes place in the cavity of the _ cell, and that the ovum passes from thence into the ovicell— there, as in a marsupial pouch, to undergo its further deve- lopment. The testis has a similar form and structure, and its position is invariably at the bottom of the cell in Bugula flabellata, B. plumosa, and Scrupocellaria scruposa, but that of the ovarium varies greatly. Thus in B. flabellata the ovarium is placed at the middle of the back of the cell, and is not directly connected with the funiculus; in B. plumosa, it lies at the apex of the back of the cell; in Scrupocellaria scruposa, it is at the upper and back part of the cell. The ovarium rarely presents more than one or two ova. On the Rerropuctive Oreans of certain Funai, with some re- marks on Germination. No. II. By Frepericx Currey, Esq., M.A. Tue following paper is intended as a sequel to a previous communication on the same subject which appeared in the last volume of this Journal (see vol. iii., p. 263.) The instances in which a particular fungus has been observed to produce a variety of fruits differmg essentially from one another, are already very numerous, and are daily on the increase. This polymorphism of fructification is highly interesting and im- portant, not only in a physiological point of view, but from the effect which it must necessarily have upon the classifica- tion of the vast tribe of Fungi. Not only have different genera of the same order been already proved to be identical, but Fungi originally classed in different orders, and appa- rently of widely-different habits and structures, have been proved to be the produce of the same mycelium. The facts which I proceed to mention, are principally the result of observations made since the publication of my former paper, and they will, I hope, be considered interesting additions to this branch of microscopical science. 1. AsrErosrortum Horrmanni—Aunze.—The fungus known by the name of Asterosporium Hoffmanni is a plant which is frequently met with in this country upon twigs of beech. It was originally ranged under S¢i/bospora, but was separated by Kunze as long ago as the year 1819, and erected into a separate genus. Although the very peculiar shape of its spores affords some grounds for this separation, the plant accords in every other respect with Stilbospora, in which genus it is still retained by some mycologists. Each one of the CURREY, ON REPRODUCTIVE ORGANS OF FUNGI. 193 spores of this singular plant consists of four bi, tri, or quadri- septate pointed cones radiating from a common centre, but the axes of which do not lie in the same plane. I have called the rays cones, but this is not strictly correct, inasmuch as they are generally slightly curved like a cow’s horn. The spores have been compared to the instrument called crow’s- Jeet, which, when thrown on the ground, always present one point upwards, as would manifestly be the case with these spores. In fig. 1, Pl. XI., I have represented a spore as seen under a magnifying power of 500 diameters. I would ob- serve, that although the normal number of rays is four, I have met with spores in which two of the rays have failed, thereby producing the appearance shown in fig. 2, which represents one of these abnormal spores magnified 350 diameters. Spores of this latter kind were tolerably numerous in one or two of the specimens which I lately examined, and upon which the observations to which this paper relates were made. The threads of the mycelium are of a brownish colour, sometimes septate, and not unfrequently branched. In the specimens just mentioned these threads were so closely packed as to present somewhat the appearance of a membrane composed of elongated cells, but nevertheless, upon close inspection, it might be seen that the threads were not actually adherent to one another. The spores of Asterosporium, like those of the Stilbospore in general, eventually produce a fissure in the bark under which they grow, and are ejected from beneath the epidermis; if the atmosphere be moist they have the appearance of tubercles of black jelly covering the twigs upon which the plant grows, but which tubercles, in hot weather, cease to be gelatinous, and become hard and dry. I must now direct attention to a plant which has hitherto been considered quite distinct from Asterosporium, and which bears the somewhat uneuphonious, but withal expressive, name of Myriocephalum botryosporum. This fungus, which has all the characters of a Stilbospora, was placed by M. Mon- tagne in that genus, but has borne a variety of names. It is the Cheirospora of Fries, the Rhabdosporium of Chevallier, the Hyperomyxa of Corda, the Botryosporium of Schweinitz, and the Myriocephalum of De Notaris, and Fresenius. It may be recognized under the microscope at a glance, by the peculiar grape-like bunches of green spores borne on the apices of long slender filaments, which are sometimes, though not generally, branched. Fig. 3 represents the upper part of one of these filaments terminating in a bunch of spores ; and fig. 4 repre- sents a similar bunch of spores, in which, as I have observed to be the case in many instances, the terminal spore, and 194 CURREY, ON REPRODUCTIVE ORGANS OF FUNGI. sometimes the ¢wo upper spores, considerably exceed in dia- meter those spores which are lower in the chain. Fig. 3 is magnified 500, and fig. 4, 350 diameters. In the first week of January in the present year, several dead branches of a beech-tree, ina wood near the Weybridge Station of the South-Western Railway, were covered with spots, each consisting of a small circular black stain, with a central papilla. A few days later, a large quantity of rain having fallen in the interval, and the atmosphere having been unusually moist, the spots had increased considerably in size, and assumed a pulvinate or hemispherical shape. A vertical section of one of these pulvinuli, carried down through the bark, presented the appearance shown by fig. 5. The epidermis was lifted up, and a conical cavity formed between that and the inner bark. This conical cavity was completely filled with the brown- coloured mycelium above-mentioned, the threads of which lay excessively close to one another. This mycelium was covered with the ordinary spores of Asterosporium Hoffmanni, similar to the one shown in fig. 1. In one or two of the plants many of the spores of the Asterosporium had assumed the form shown in fig. 2, and in other instances, multicellular spores without horns existed in considerable quantities, always towards the lowest portion of the conical cavity. The gelati- nous tubercle which crowned the cavity, and the section of which is seen in fig. 5 above the lacinie of the epidermis, consisted of elongated white threads enveloped in a mucous medium, each thread bearing at its apex bunches of spores such as those shown in figs. 8 and 4. A careful examination of a number of specimens quite satisfied me that the white threads were prolongations of the brown mycelium, the threads of the latter becoming gradually narrower and paler in colour in approaching towards their summit. In short, the pale brown filaments which filled the cavity beneath the epidermis, and which bore the spores of the t xooo In. made a very careful drawing, by the camera lucida, of a portion of one of these tubes, magnified about 800 diameters. But the opposed ends of these divided spirals do not termi- nate similarly ; for while one extremity exhibits a fine point, the other is forked, dividing into two portions, each having a MEMORANDA. 239 fine point, and which, together, are very nearly the shape of a semicircle. These simple points (A, fig. 1) and forks (s) alternate along both sides of the line of division, the forked extremity of one divided spiral being placed in juxtaposition with the simple point of the adjacent fibre. It is evident that the portion which I have endeavoured to draw, although showing this structure very clearly, is rather distorted in the process of mounting (mounted by Topping); but from what may be seen in other portions of this specimen, I believe that a tube quite undistorted would present something of the appearance of figure 2. This very beautiful structure is obscurely indi- cated in the positive photograph by Mr. Delves, alluded to above. By carefully examining the proboscis with a power of about 200 diameters, it appears as though these tubes are connected together by a delicate, structureless membrane, not on the same plane, with the membrane accurately represented in figure 29 a, Plate 26, of the ‘ Micrographic Dictionary ;’ in which figure, however, the peculiar features of the “ divided absorbent tube ” do not appear (with all due deference to the talented Authors) to be characteristically drawn.—G. Hunt, Handsworth, near Birmingham. Aperture of Object-Glasses. — Professor Bailey having admitted that the effect of balsam mounting is to cause a reduction of the angle of aperture of the object-glass, any further remarks from me in defence of this position are almost superfluous. A scientific controversy should not, perhaps, be avoided, if its sole end is to establish the truth—my arguments on the subject in question have been entirely dictated by this motive. If I have at all misunderstood Professor Bailey, it has not been either intentionally or wilfully, for the few words to which his last comments relate might readily bear the inter- pretation that I put upon them. He stated that my argu- ments were erroneous, and gave as the single reason that I had “traced the rays into the balsam instead of out of it;” I must confess that I inferred from this that Professor Bailey meant to imply that a ray traced outwards would be refracted at a different angle of emergence relative to the degree of incidence, than if the same ray was traced inwards. As this can never be the case, and the discussion related to one point only, viz., the aperture of the object-glass, or angle of rays collected from an object in balsam, therefore, with all submis- sion, I think that I was not in fault in saying that it comes to precisely the same thing if the rays are traced into the re- fractive medium or out of it, as far as the actual result is concerned. 240 MEMORANDA. The refractive effect of balsam causes but a small compara- tive difference in favour of extreme degrees: for example, referring to my former experiments, two object-glasses, one of 146° and the other of 105° of aperture, will be reduced over an object in balsam to 75° and 68°, being a difference of forty-one degrees in air, but only seven degrees in balsam, In discussing this subject, I have omitted to mention that balsam- mounting not only has the effect of another optical combina- tion by the refractive medium reducing the aperture, but that the same refraction also slightly diminishes the magnifying power of the object-glass. This may be easily proved by measuring the length of an object both before and after fluid balsam has been allowed to run under the thin glass cover, using a 1-12th objective —F. H. Wenuam. Application of Collodion to the Production of Stage and Eye-piece Micrometers for the Wicroscope.— A cheap stage-micrometer may be made by taking a cast in collodion from a piece of ruled glass, and mounting the cast thus taken as a microscopic slide. The specimen sent with this is one of many casts taken in this way from a piece of glass on which lines had been ruled at the distance of 1-400ths of an inch, Every irregularity in the original is accurately copied on the collo- dion ; and by this planone correctly-ruled micrometer on glass may be made to furnish any require dnumber of exact copies. An eye-piece micrometer may be made in a very simple manner, by employing the photographic camera to reduce a coarsely-graduated original to any degree of minuteness which may be desired. ‘The specimens sent with this are copies of a scale of inches and tenths, reduced in this way either to tenths and hundredths or to twentieths and two-hundredths ; and also of a diagonal scale reduced so as to furnish for the eye-piece of the microscope a micrometer of which the divi- sions are hundredths and thousandths of an inch. The originals are of glass, covered with black paper or black varnish, on which lines were drawn with a knife-point. These micrometers are not perhaps so sharp as those ruled by machines, but they may be made at a much smaller cost, of any required pattern and size, and by those who have no machines within their reach.—W. Hopeson, Old Brathay. Note on Pinnularia.— At the first page of this volume of the ‘Quarterly Journal of Microscopical Science, Dr. Gregory, noticing a Pnnularia, for which he had adopted Professor Smith’s name of Pinnularia latestriata, proceeds thus:—* I could find no figure of this species in any work to which I had access, neither in Ehrenberg’s Atlas in 1838, in Kutzing, MEMORANDA. 241 nor in Rabenhorst. Nor did any English observer know it. But I now find that Ehrenberg had described it as P. borealis, ten or twelve years ago, although his figure, which, if pub- lished, appeared in the Berlin Transactions or the Berlin Monthly Reports, was entirely unknown to all our authorities in this country, none of whom, more than myself, have been able to consult Ehrenberg’s very numerous papers on the Berlin Transactions or Monthly Reports, except as quoted by Kutzing or Rabenhorst, neither of whom noticed this species. { mention these facts to explain how it was that a species long ago described, and I believe figured, by Ehrenberg, was regarded by all our authorities as new when [ found it in the Mull earth two years ago.” Allow me briefly and respectfully to state, that the Pin- nularia borealis is figured by Kutzing, and is figured by Rabenhorst ; and that Kutzing copied his figure from Ehren- berg’s American Tabule, a work by no means unknown in this country.—J. On Micrometers and Micrometry—I[n the last number of the ‘Microscopical Journal,’ there is a paper by Dr. Robertson, quoted from the ‘ Monthly Journal of Medical Science,’ re- commending an ingenious form of eye-piece micrometer, pro- posed by Herman Welcher, a medical student at Giessen, on which I wish to offer a few observations. Micrometry, as affected by the compound microscope, consists in the comparison of the magnified image of the object with the similarly-magnified image of a body whose dimensions are known, the most convenient for the purpose being a piece of glass ruled with fine divisions, called a stage micrometer. ‘This comparison cannot, as Dr. Robertson correctly observes, be made directly by laying the object on the divided scale; but it may be made indirectly, either by the camera lucida, as practised by Mr. Lister, or by means of an eye-piece micrometer. The latter method, in addition to convenience in application, has the further advantage of sub- dividing the divisions on the stage to an extent corresponding to the magnifying power employed; but it also has the dis- advantage of enlarging their errors in the same proportion. In ruling a micrometer, the elasticity of the materials of the dividing engine, the friction of its moving parts, or the free- dom of motion necessarily allowed in order to diminish that friction, will produce a very slight inequality in the individual divisions ; but if these be carefully examined, their errors will generally be found to be alternately plus and minus, in no case cumulative. It therefore follows that the sum of the errors of a number of divisions will scarcely ever exceed that 242 MEMORANDA. ~* of an individual one, and will probably be much less. The advantage, then, of taking a large space of the stage micro- meter as a basis for estimating the value of that in the eye- piece is quite evident ; for, not only is the absolute amount of error likely to be less, but that amount will be proportionally diminished in measuring all smaller objects, whereas it would be increased in measuring larger ones. In the micrometer recommended by Dr. Robertson, the object is made to occupy the chord of an arc, and the extent that can be measured by it is the diameter of the dotted circle described by the revolution of the point of intersection of the lines a b and cd, fig. 2, p. 155. To find the value of this quantity, make the line cd parallel and coincident with one of the divisions of the stage micro- meter, then turn the eye-piece half round, and when the same line is again parallel to a division, read off the number of divisions passed over, which will be equal to the chord of 180°, or twice the size of 90°. The chord, then, of any ob- served angle will bear the same proportion to the chord of 180°, that the sine of half the angle does to the sine of 90°; and as the latter quantity is taken as unity in the tables of sines, the calculation becomes quite easy, either by logarithms, whole numbers, or the sliding-scale. Whether this instru- ment is capable of the accuracy assigned to it by Dr. Robert- son, must depend on the relative position of the eye-piece and the object on the stage remaining znvariable during the opera- tion; and this can only be insured by sound workmanship in the maker, and delicate manipulation in the observer. The latter, however, will, I think, find some difficulty in placing the line to be measured (which may be either in the length or breadth of an object) in the exact direction of the chord of the tmaginary circle (for there is no trace of it in the microscope) ; and the calculations, though simple, will become wearisome when often repeated. When Dr. Pereira was engaged on the last edition of his ‘ Materia Medica,’ I made the measurements of the different starch-globules for him; and as I generally measured eight or ten in each specimen, I am sure that it would have taken me a much longer time than I spent over it to accomplish the task with the above instru- ment. The eye-piece micrometer that I used was a glass one, furnished with the fine-movement screw, described in the transactions of the Microscopical Society, and in Mr Quekett's treatise. It was divided into 250ths of an inch, and, by means of a draw-tube, was made to read 10,000ths with the quarter inch object-glass employed. The measurements may therefore be relied on to the 30,000th of an inch; for the third, or even fourth of a division can be easily estimated. MEMORANDA. 243 Dr. Robertson complains that in glass micrometers “ the breadth of the lines is so considerable, and the shadows caused by their channels are so perplexing,” that extreme accuracy is unattainable with them. From his constantly speaking of millimeters, I conclude that the micrometers he has used are of French manufacture, some of which, as I have seen, are justly liable to his censure, for they appear to have been ruled by a diamond which cuts, or rather splits, the glass like that employed by glaziers. But micrometers may be obtained from most of the makers in London, in which the lines are only thick enough to be dis- tinctly visible ; and the channels being filled with plumbago, and having a cover cemented over them with Canada balsam, cast no shadows when in the focus of the eye-glass, the shadows which Dr. Robertson complains of, being most probably the refraction of the prismatic edges of the channels—GrorcE Jackson, 30, Church Street, Spitalfields. Vir. Amyet’s Finder.— You were good enough to insert a short paper of mine on the “ Finder or Indicator” in the last number of the ‘ Microscopical Journal ;’ I have since had some lithographed scales struck off for pasting on the face of the wooden instrument, and have had the pleasure of supply- ing a considerable number of these to gentlemen unknown to me, and to whom I have not had time to write full directions for attaching them. Indeed it is only within the last few days that I have hit upon a mode of effecting this with ease and satisfaction to myself. If you would be good enough to insert the few necessary directions which I have condensed to the utmost, you would confer an additional obligation. Directions for attaching the Lithographic Paper Scales to the Wooden Indicator, described at page 151 of the last Number of the Journal. 1. Continue the lines of the four scales across the centre of the paper, using a fine-pointed pencil. ] 2. Perforate the central intersection of lines with a needle. 3. Cover the face of the wooden instrument with a thin layer of smooth paste, the bone disk being removed. 4. Force the little brass pin out of the bone, and replace the disk on its rabbet. 5. Place the paper on the wood, inclosing the bone, and then holding the instrument up to the light, bring the needle-hole exactly opposite to that in the bone, and ascertain with a lens that this is correctly done. 6. Smooth the paper on the wood, and before putting aside to dry again ascertain that the centres are correct. 7. In about two hours remove the middle of the paper at the ring with a sharp-pointed penknife. Take out the bone disk, replace the pin, and trim the edge of the paper so neatly that the centre-piece may fall easily in its place. Tuomas E. Amyort, Diss, Norfolk. (0) BA PROCEEDINGS OF SOCIETIES. MicroscoricaL Society, December 26, 1855. Dr. Carrenter, President, in the chair. H. Griesbach, Esq. ; —. Pillischer, Esq. ; F. Haes, Esq.; and Dr. Stevens, were balloted for, and duly elected. A list of persons proposed as Officers and Council for the year ensuing was read, and ordered to be suspended in the Meeting-room. Dr. Lankester read three papers, printed in the Journal. Dr. Beale exhibited and described a new form of Microscope. January 30, 1856. Dr. CarPrenTeER, President, in the chair. J. Slade, Esq.; Dr. W. Rawlins; J. S. Gaskoines, Esq.; C. W. Quin, Esq. ; C. A. Long, Esq.; and H. Sidden, Esq., were balloted for, and duly elected. Certain proposed additions and alterations in the Laws of the Society were read, and ordered to be suspended in the Meeting- room. Feb. 27, 1856. ANNIVERSARY MEETING. Dr. Carpenter, President, in the chair. A report from the Council and from the Auditors of the Treasurer’s accounts was read, and ordered to be received and approved. The alterations and additions in the Laws, proposed at the last Meeting, were read and adopted. The President then delivered an address. Dr. Lister; H. Morris, Esq.; Chas. Rivaz, Esq.; and C. W. Gregory, Esq., were balloted for, and duly elected (see Transactions, p. 15). ( 245 ) ORIGINAL COMMUNICATIONS. Nores on the Structure of Oscitiatori®, with a Description of a New Species, possessing a most remarkable Locomotive Power, not Citta. By Dr. F. p’Atquen. (Plate XIV.) Tue study of the structure of the Oscillatorie is particularly interesting, from the fact that we may not unreasonably expect to find in it a key to the singular motion from which they have received their generic name, and which now, for more than a century,* has formed an object of curiosity and interest to the microscopist without having received as yet a satis- factory explanation. In one species at least, I think, I have been able to make out the leading features of its structure and the mechanism of its locomotion. The description of this, to me, new species I wish to preface by a few observa- tions, containing some new facts regarding the structure of Oscillatoria in general, which may, perhaps, interest some of your readers ; in doing so, it will, however, not be necessary to refer to the general character of these interesting organisms, as they must be familiarly known to every one who is in the habit of using the microscope,.and therefore I plunge at once in medias res. The following different tissues are observable in the true Oscillatorie :— 1. An outer enclosing sheath ; 2. A special cell-membrane, with its contents ; and 3. The axis, or pith, of the filament ; which we shall consider in the order here stated. The filaments of certain species are enclosed in sheaths (vagine) or continuous tubes, never showing any cross- markings corresponding to the striz of the filament; they are composed of a kind of cellulose, since, though they remain unaffected by iodine, I have never been able to produce, on subjecting them to the usual tests for cellulose, that peculiar and striking blue colour characteristic of this substance. In other species, these tubes are wanting, or have not yet been observed. They are easily recognized; when present, they will be found projecting on one or both sides of the filament, being considerably longer than the latter. Filaments enclosed in their sheaths never, or but slightly, exhibit their peculiar motions, though they may be seen sliding in them, back * Their movements were first observed by Adanson in 1753. VOL. LV. Ss 246 ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIA. and forwards, or leaving them altogether; in the latter instance, the filament, on sliding out, receives an impetus, as it seems, from the sudden cessation of the impediment pre- sented by the sheath to its forward motion. While sliding within its sheath, I have repeatedly observed that the tapering and bent extremity of the filament in its progress altered its position with regard to the sides of the sheath, now pointing upwards, now downwards; performing, therefore, a kind of rotation around its own axis in its progress. The filaments themselves have been supposed to consist wholly of protoplasm; this view is not correct, since the protoplasm is enclosed in a proper cell-membrane, which has not, to my knowledge, been noticed before. This cellulose coat always shows the cross-markings corresponding to the striae when such were observable in the filament, and which divide it into distinct joints or cells; these cells, however, seem to be what Kiitzing calls “ cellule hologonimice”’ cells, completely filled out by the gonimic substance, or endochrome, which circumstance causes the cells to resume their former shape, after desiccation, on the addition of water, and accounts for the difficulty of demonstrating their struc- ture. They form, with the protoplasm deposited in them, annular bands or concentric rings, around the solid axis of the filament (formatio perigenata).. A reference to Pl. XIV., fig 7, will render its structure more intelligible. The presence of this cell-membrane may be best demonstrated by breaking up the filaments, either by moving the thin glass cover, or by cutting through a mass of them in all directions with a pair of fine dissecting knives. On now examining the slide, in most instances many detached empty pieces of this cell- membrane, with its striz, will be found, as well as filaments partly deprived of the protoplasm, showing in those places the empty, striated cellulose coat, figs. 1,2. On-the subsequent addition of iodine all these appearances will become unmis- takeably evident; the entire portions of the filament turning brown or red, while the empty, with its striae, remain either unaffected, or at most present a slight yellowish tint, as is frequently the case with cellulose when old, for instance. (PI. XIV., figs. 3, 8,11.) Many specimens, however, do not readily show the above appearances, but require some trouble and management, while others do so readily enough; this arises from the peculiar state they are in; as a general rule, I found that those which admit of being easily broken up are the most fit for demonstrating this cell-membrane. In case it might be imagined I had mistaken the external enclosing sheath for the cell-membrane, I will observe that I have repeatedly isolated ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIE. 247 filaments plainly enclosed in their sheaths, and have in- variably been able to demonstrate the different tissues referred ‘ to, viz., the plain wnstriated cellulose sheath, and the striated special or proper cell-membrane of the filament, deprived of its protoplasm. Moreover, the sheaths never have any striz corresponding to the joints of the filament, and I am rather inclined to think that other observers, mistaking the cell- membrane for the enclosing sheath, have been prevented from earlier establishing the presence of the former, because J am convinced, as it has been stated that the sheaths seldom show any striz, that, where these striz were observed, the cell- membrane has been mistaken for the sheath. With regard to the contents of this cell-membrane, it has already been stated that the protoplasm (or endochrome, since it is coloured in the Oscillatorie) is deposited within it, in the form of circular bands or rings, around the axis of the cylindrical filament; they are evidently of a nitrogenous com- position, coloured by chlorophyll; iodine turns them brown or red, and syrup and dilute sulphuric acid produce a beau- tiful rose colour. The cells seem, however, not uniformly filled with it, but its deposition is in some places less dense than in others, as, for instance, in the centre. This circum- stance, as well as that the cells are formed round the solid axis of the filament, must be borne in mind on examining the filaments while under the action of various chemical reagents. By means of these latter, I think, it may be satisfactorily proved that the filaments are really composed of separate cells ; syrup causes them to contract by erosmose, and, if it is replaced by water, they resume their original shape by endosmose (figs. 4, 5, 6). Another question, however, is, are these cells in simple apposition without an intervening cellu- lose wall, or what kind of connexion, if any, exists between them? This question is not easily answered, but I am almost convinced that the striz of the cell-membrane represent distinct joints, forming a cellulose wall, as represented in the ideal section, fig. 7 b, because I have never observed .the endochrome recede beyond the striz on the addition of a strong solution of chloride of calcium; and the lenticular disks (fig. 9), or single joints, when on end, can bear any pressure short of their entire destruction without displacement of the endochrome, which would hardly be the case if it were not enclosed within a proper cell. Further, in detached empty pieces of the cell-membrane, some of the striae are often seen out of their natural position, dividing the cells obliquely, having been ruptured; and lastly, as there can be hardly any doubt that the filaments consist of a series of s 2 248 ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIZ. cells, I think, from the presence of the proper cell-membrane, it might be reasonably inferred that the septa likewise con- sisted of cellulose, though difficult of positive demonstration on account of their minute and delicate structure. On the other hand, I must not omit to mention that I witnessed what would lead one to think that a kind of immediate contact existed between the cell contents; so soon as the points a and b in fig. 8, which represents a part of a filament under the action of iodine, began to recede from the cross-markings, the opposite portions in the intermediate adjoining cells retracted simultaneously, just as if a separation had taken place. The axis of the filament may be compared to the pith or medullary sheath (stratum medullare) of the Dicotyledons ; it is solid, highly refractive, but slightly affected by iodine, and, under a very high power, a granular appearance may be distinctly seen in the very centre when the filaments are broken up, and a single joint, which on end resembles a lenticular disc, is examined. If the filaments are allowed to dry spontaneously on a glass slide, a greenish thread may, with a little care, be traced running through the middle of the filament from one end to another. This is more decidedly the case if the filaments have been previously treated by iodine, fig. 10. While moist, no trace of this thread is to be seen, owing to its being almost colourless, and rendered trans- parent by the water; after desiccation, however, it acquires colour by condensation or shrinking, and becomes visible ; sometimes, also, it will be found protruding, and in other instances I have seen it keeping up the connexion of cells, otherwise separated, fig. 11. After the addition of a weak syrup, I have also frequently observed an appearance which seems to countenance the view I have taken, and is shown in fig. 4. With regard to their propagation nothing positive is known. If kept for some time they gradually lose their green colour ; those exposed to the sun much sooner, | think, than others less exposed to its direct rays; the stratum eventually be- coming brown, sinks to the bottom of the containing vessel ; it presents a granular layer, embodying great numbers of filaments in all stages of decay, and, what is very singular, a great number of Amaba will be found feasting on them, with swarms of lively Infusoria of the Monadina kind, briskly flourishing their single flagelliform cilium about in al] direc- tions. I must also mention here a modification the filaments are sometimes observed to undergo, which is represented in figs. 12 and 138. Some of the cells, namely, contract in the middle, and their colour becomes much deeper and more ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIA. 249 brilliant; in other instances the cells assume more of a globular shape, and in this case, the filament, which is usually straight, deviates to the right or left after each globular ex- pansion, and from both sides tapers down into it. I believe the latter form is but a more mature state of the former; and ultimately, at these joints, the filaments separate, setting the globular cells free, which may, perhaps, justly be regarded as gonidia. In other filaments the striz are fermed ; as it seems, by a number of granules, though I believe they are in reality to be found on each side of the cross-markings. As these granules are only observabie in some of the filaments, and in others of the same species not, | think they denote a peculiar stage of development, and I am strongly impressed with the notion that these bodies are in some way connected with reproduction. The growth of the Oscillatorie has been stated by some to be so rapid that they grow 10-12 times their length in as many hours, and others have gone so far as to attribute their motions to the rapidity of their growth. My observations have taught me to regard these notions as entirely unfounded and fanciful. Even Kutzing seems to share these extravagant notions regarding their growth. He says (‘ Phycologia Germ. p- 157, note): “ All the Oscillatorie grow so fast that their growth may be watched and followed up while under obsery- ation with the microscope; this fact explains the pheno- menon, that when they are slowly dried on paper in masses, the evens are prolonged in all directions, forming a ray around the mass.” With all due regard for this distinguished algologist, I think the fact cited admits of another, and what seems to me the true explanation; the Aas ae. namely, creep out from the mass, if I may apply this term to their motions, wherever the presence of water facilitates their movements ; in drying a mass of them on paper, the water will naturally collect for some time at its circumference, and allow the filaments to riggle out, forming thus the ray men- tioned by Kiitzing. The formation of this ray is, therefore, due to their protrusion, and not to a prolongation of the filaments themselves, which alone is implied when speaking of their growth. I have frequently observed, if a small portion of ate flaky stratum of Oscillatoria, of a deep, glossy greenish- black colour, as found under damp walls, covering the damp ground to the extent of several feet, be placed in a watch- glass with water, in a short time nearly the whole extent of the glass will be found covered with single filaments, forming a kind of pellicle, and at first sight this might be taken for an instance of their remarkable growth ; but on examination, the 250 ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIA. small portion of stratum will be found almost completely deserted, bare, deprived of its deep glossy colour, which depended upon the presence of crowded masses of filaments, which have forsaken their home and wandered forth under the stimulus of the surrounding liquid element. Strange to say, after about a fortnight the sides of the glass were less crowded, the stratum having regained a little more colour, and one could almost feel inclined to attach some truth to the naive statement of the same observer, that the filaments leave their sheaths to which they return when it is cold, &c. As everything relating to their natural history is of some interest, J will mention another: observation I accidentally made. Having emptied a bottle containing a stock of Oscillatoria, and finding the sides of the bottle in several places covered with them, I detached them from the’sides, having previously filled the bottle with water; the next morning I observed, with some surprise, the rising bottom of the bottle covered with a tolerably dense green stratum, but not a trace of any of the detached pieces which I had left could be found; they must, therefore, have crowded together, forming a little colony of their own, being, as it seems, of a social disposition, and gregarious in their habits. The new species of Oscillatoria* which I shall now de- scribe is peculiarly interesting, from its being apparently in a state of transition, not having its cells filled out by chloro- phyll, and thus admitting of a better observation of its in- ternal structure; it was found forming an extensive, partly frothy, stratum, of a dirty-green colour (drying blue-green or zruginous), on stagnant water, and on being disturbed it sepa- rated into small threads, having a twisted, curly appearance. The average diameter of filaments is 1-6000"; diameter of cells about the same; they are highly refractive, and the most active I have as yet observed. I have stated they were apparently in a transition state, because, besides those which have their cells not coloured by chlorophyll, and which form the great mass of them, there are others with only a few cells filled out, appearing green; and again, others with all the cells of the filaments filled up, and in this, what 1 suppose to be their mature state, they resemble the usual forms the Oscillatorie present, viz., filaments of a green colour, only that in this instance the strie are very indistinctly developed. In those with transparent, uncoloured cells the striae are well * Though apparently common, I have not been able to identify it with any of the great number described by Kiitzing ; but as it may nevertheless be known, I have refraimed for the present from introducing it under a specific name. ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORLE. 251 marked ; and through the middle of the filament runs a deep green thread, somewhat tortuous like a swollen vein, perforat- ing and connecting the cells from one end of the filament to the other, forming its axis, and presenting an instance of a contractile substance serving as an apparatus for locomotion unexampled in the annals of vegetable physiology (figs, 14, 15). Their structure is, however, not so simple as one would imagine from the description and drawings I have given; they present, on the contrary, so complicated and varying an aspect, that it is next to impossible to give an adequate repre- sentation of them. However, under a good object-glass (1-8th), and at a certain focus, they appear as simple as represented ; and I would add, it is only when seen thus that their extraordinary motions, which differ in some respects from those of other Osczllatori@, may be clearly observed. The motions of the Oscillatorie are indeed so singular that while some have in vain attempted to explain them as partly external and altogether physical, others are not wanting who have come to the conclusion that they must be animalcula, solely on the strength of their apparent voluntary movements. Dr. Hassall, for instance, on the former supposition, says : “The filaments are very straight and elastic, and when they are placed for observation on the field of the microscope, they are bent out of their natural straight line, and make an effort to recover it ; currents almost imperceptible in the liquid in which they are immersed, and perhaps unequal attractions, are causes amply sufficient to explain their motions.” The most superficial examination, however, is sufficient to show the futility of these arguments, and I would refer the reader for a complete answer to them to a note of Captain Car- michael, which will be found in Hooker’s ‘ Flora’ under Oscillatoria ; and I will only add that a drop of Tincture of Iodine, or an aqueous Tincture of Opium,* does neither interfere with their efforts to recover their straight line, 7. e., with their elasticity, nor with the imperceptible currents of the liquid in which they are immersed, but, nevertheless, puts a stop to their motions. But, before referring further to the cause of these motions, it will perhaps be desirable to define strictly in what they consist. They are, generally, not inaptly described as the oscillating of a balance with an advance in a longitudinal direction; but I must mention that sometimes these motions are slow, at others quick and effected by jerks, but the motion itself consists in the revolving of the filaments; they roll over and over, and forward with a sudden start and then recoil, so that their * Exposure to the vapours cf chloroform produces the same effect. . 252 ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIA. forward motion is active and the recoil passive. To observe this well, the very uppermost surface of the filaments ought to be brought in focus, leaving the margins rather undefined, bearing in mind that the filament is not a flat but a cylindrical body. As to the cause of these motions, or the mechanism by which they are effected, nothing positive is known; Dr. Kingsley has observed the whole surface of a large species to be covered with cilia, moving in a circular wave round the axis of the filament. (Mic. Journal, No. xi. p. 243.) It would be of the greatest interest to have this observation con- firmed, as the presence of cilia would in a very great measure explain their motions. As a further reason for such con- firmation, I would assign the fact of having discovered, as I believe, in the new species just described, a locomotive appa- ratus within the filament, independent of cilia. While attentively examining the green thread running through the middle of the filament, it suddenly vanished in one cell, and appeared more prominent in the next to it, repeatedly altering its position in different cells, now vanishing, now appearing again, without any other perceptible motion than a gentle tremor of the filament. After more extended observation the movement appeared to me to consist in a lateral deflection and retraction of the thread. If the left hand, for instance, is closed, and now the index-finger of the same hand is alter- nately extended and bent, if the hand is not too plump, the tendinous termination of the indicator muscle in its retraction will be seen on the back of the hand to slip to the left side, forming a curve, and to resume its former position on bending the finger. This will give a very fair idea of what I saw at that time. At last, however, having obtained a fresh supply of this Oscillatoria, 1 observed, as I have since never failed to do, in a filament of about six or eight joints, the most active size, and therefore the most fit for observation, what I consider to be its true motion. The thread suddenly began to spin round, while the filament was set in active motion, passing quickly out of the field with the corkscrew-like movement of a very active vibrio. I have said, the thread suddenly began to spin round—at least so it then appeared, though further experiments have now convinced me, that the filament itself revolves at the same time, as is the case with other species of Oscillatoria—but its progressive motion only being seen, the whirling movement seems to be confined to the strongly-marked green axis or thread which divides the cells longitudinally. I confess, on making this last discovery, the pleasure I felt on first beholding, what I could but regard as the locomotive apparatus of the filament, was greatly dimi- ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIZ. 253 nished, since the question arises, is the spinning round of the thread the primum mobile, the agency by which the motion of the filament is effected, or is the motion of the latter due to another cause, say for instance, ciliary action, in which latter case the apparent motion of the axis or thread might be accounted for by the revolving of the filament, which not being distinctly observable would have the same effect as if the thread alone spun round in propelling the filament. Still after the most careful and patient observation, [ must retain my original opinion, viz., of the thread possessing independent motion, and being the cause of the motion of the filament, for the following reasons. I purposely watched and repeatedly observed, while only the most gentle oscillations were observ- able in the filament, the thread which was very distinct in two adjoining cells, vanish out of one and not out of the other. The gentle tremor of the filament could hardly be due to a revolving of the filament; but even supposing it did revolve at the time, as the thread in both cells was equally prominent ; if its disappearance in one cell was owing to the revolving of the filament, it ought also to have disappeared in the other cell for the same reason. Similar appearances | have observed in filaments which were partly bent, approaching the figure 8S, and which could not have revolved around their axis without its being plainly seen; yet, as in the former instance, the thread could be seen altering its position in the different cells. As a further reason for retaining my original opinion, I will mention that by careful observation the body of the filament itself may sometimes be seen to bend simultaneously while the thread is seen to retract in the manner described above, And, lastly, though using all the best means which have been recommended by experienced observers, for the detection of cilia, | have been unable to discover any ; and I would caution other observers, in looking for them, not to mistake certain appearances presented by the filaments under oblique light and an object-glass of great angular aperture, which closely resemble a fringe of cilia, though they are simply the result of the highly refractive property of the filaments. I have been thus particular in stating what I have seen, as I am most anxious that other observers, with superior means of investigation, whom I hope to induce to verify or correct my own observations, should exactly know what I had seen ; and as I have provided myself with a good stock of this interesting species, I shall be very happy to forward some of it to those who feel interested, and inclined to investigate for themselves what I consider to be a most important point in vegetable physiology, viz., the various motions observable in 254 ON THE STRUCTURE OF OSCILLATORIZ. plants. On this head [ would offer in conclusion a few observations, in order to show that the present state of our knowledge in this respect is far from satisfactory. Almost every day brings forth a discovery by which the old landmarks established in science for the arrangement and classification of the various products of our planet are unset- tled, and this is more particularly the case as regards those two kingdoms, the lower forms of which approach so near one another, that, for want of distinctive characters, we cannot always draw a positive line of demarcation between them. This state of uncertainty, though partly the natural result of the very nature and conditions of the objects to which it refers, still prevails to a greater extent than is warranted, and must continue to do so until our present notions on this subject have undergone a thorough revision, In my opinion, the boundary assigned to the vegetable kingdom is too limited ; our definition of a vegetable organism must be enlarged, and we may vindicate for plants many attributes hitherto exclu- sively attributed to animals, though, as a necessary conse- quence of the more limited sphere of activity characteristic of vegetable life in general, they will necessarily be manifested in a less prominent manner; but this should not mislead us so far as to ignore their existence altogether, and how vast a difference in the manifestation of the various attributes of life is observable even amongst animals themselves? * 7 es i ‘ ; ~ f a sy N ‘ aa sf j —- _ eee 1 eee E Pa wae ae 5) F is eae a m ' ey ¥ emer | VAL eS > 4 : * chs 4 Cet i: ; 4 - - se _ i fa wis > & -. ; - ; 7 a Ps i : # - ee 4 al es boat : “4 y * - » 4 | = = iS - 5 ad ms - se oN pte JAOIIORBOAOIM AO TAVUOL a ; 2h. ng ate woreaoENd | - q } ar 4 ty let cro Ao, gay Heinin'T’ Pais ynitd (vitau IT “4 7 ne ——- ; “oe é ae Fai ban wast vil iEaiel ¥) HF hot 2 Tinie yoy) Tints Fad: . poi REL soba vil dp vornn pont eval (8) Tite — on $2 (4) pid : ‘ tite z Par fa) dor it lions BW ial os Wott no AB ee RO Aston sult AW aprisaig bovariny pol = a Wypitea aie sat. AUS OED an {inion oki We yd die iy : ahs mi gantirenim bie pried ml ko Holy mn with, hi Muu yee i biTh 6 Mor duel nid a Loi Son ieee TOI MAR ET a POT el ot ait Th ith it Ee ; § 0M) %e. Daan ot v0) oi sats 4 hose? ae ati ‘Aujtecniehet 7? ; a 3 Asi} 5 LU foiaieot ail (lohilw a ms - F Sovell ilabitar Mp Wrat 1 ) ovid piel eo ie) Watiol) aietone We Ga a eat Bie ail VR Gy wT 5 hits Few te st aire 28 dan Goleta ‘es ‘ Ci Beer itens i srry SOE Je OO 1) ‘" ron hot fin shew Wiad oe 4 St Ea g Univ stNTHB Oi Cs) 5 destinies WI (}) OR HD. ayy a Miler Ores Voit DMT aeey iG Hi Gohl in Pleat ae, ta uBheuy , ; r hth wee iw Ain, (Ninh Th) Palin}! leiigita ‘he ringtone hemi : 4 Pre niin: (ulti e andl Argel Wediamn Ata (404 rigal (vada e; | pet. —— apr yi Taba HP We wish Ao 8) rad ep 1 r ih oki fi Pia ye uiien nie ty! viply Sy eu yd) md faant he at iw ; ., = - ed VEAL Wait nie a i irvivigaleas ont WH AMt hon s 7 a fs ih, Pt) te uM ] pith) Osit vere hae ‘Un 40 ron a CVMVE NES : aM ; ; iY pean alnniacy of) (div ‘Ae ; A ; my 2 - | | F i 7 > 7 : 4 eal i! } al ar - ai : ay a q , oe he ; . ey ¢ D Ge... ; . 7 wr > ij rD - any f ‘sl © + ~N ... ine! sf ™ a os \ ‘ Py LA 9 i iJ | 1 JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE VL, Illustrating Mr. Tomes’s paper on Dental Tissues. Fig. 1.—A section from a temporary tooth, in which the dentine (a) and the enamel (6) have been removed by absorption, leaving the festooned outline (c). 2.—A section from the fang of a tooth, in which the dentine (a) has been removed, together with the cementum (c), and again made good by the deposition of cementum. The appearance presented at the junction of the dentine and cementum, where absorption has not encroached upon the tissues at that point, is shown at (6). The curved irregular lines in the cementum indicate the extent of absorption at various periods, and the boundaries of the tissue which has replaced the lost parts. 3.—A section from a temporary tooth, the fangs of which have been absorbed, and the crown hollowed out; the enamel having been partly removed, and both tissues coated over with new cementum. (a), the dentine ; (6), the enamel; (c), the cementum; (d), the junction of the absorbed surface of the enamel and new cementum. 4.—A section of enamel, in which the centre (a) has been ground through ; (b), the enamel fibres, with their granular cells shown faintly ; (cc), the sheaths of the enamel fibres. 5.—A more highly magnified view from the same specimen, showing the sheaths of the enamel fibres and their contents. 6,—A transverse section of enamel, showing the sheaths of the fibres with the contents removed. i | ICOLObE OULE Ford & West imp Lens Aldous del. . =. RP 4 te oN ede Pe etek tis He aye | i ea Or ane Ts AD 20 aOR a = bee 7 a fo ica = : ae we eae hee, 10 MORN esa an eee ee biva Sperauen Spry: “ae pilevidane aM x will a ; ot balla ve a a inhi Aaa en aa am ORT a) aes Poy: aye uty AYe i% ny om . ale aw a . RIT Cais May) Beisibe atin eine e apt wet ot Voie ae ey “) 1 Ani ToS rs ih ay fit att: ait Ptrn: hip bean “ft LORS hina Oy i TMG) Cr; pee) Pee RON To, wat? iin tthe Wie a Bid hl Pel PMS THT: MARIE Ce TO) dy’ ls iff BUDA Ton a Asi « je piivid Pes) | piped uitAe nian motel ht eA Se ; if 1 rs || nao) wlth): Hild adn She ; } ye an © ‘ ae 10 WW OIt A) pO et a aR Nit bi hi) eg nds Oy UT fon Wh SAE NS ee Fe a ravi» yates! ny aN, 3) TE VR | ee haa te fe? Bes | ton Uta prajls air a rei) BOR co Ubiye wa 7 ee ian ales ti mas OMe OS I © Edy yr SUE et ay anid Jie al uaa 1, hanty owe all AT ply Asi oie it Wes) AL me Byiih) >: Gab iay) Dita call 4) NG ean teint) lst ¥s Sil: alii ia ee ele i a CHES efit Ss aR SA Ht 1 rt rr Ws. oi as, Se oy | rae ret net : Ree: Lea | nie eat peeling cw hor an vf 5 , ian K has AOR Bes het , ; ha i fae , F é f f hi i. ; ‘ erst heh Sate uall 1) eee 9 WR * ae Cofaivr ofa 00") N/LR Mampi nities o ape en ms | Lil ahd Cp) ee tou f ‘ ee , ral i? ii AV ie Vactiberl (3 002") ay Peer » rani} Malt Yo Mier a ARG, Sy, aaa eho figl! ot lel ae mend | Te ty - Th xobbiaeah . (eas) yA i Is an eT | 1 hosting ‘I yet : mms Ose) ) wha Uli e yd QO "ped auth otis 3h Elan hie ae A Of ON I Bea) ee) A LT Sh nd CALLIN TT tae m.. ; AY Bei fh Sey Gan lo tuot a Re ae oh ye) on i age (oie Ok Say ey ie cee 0, ain MY fh segeeaty yt haianl 2 Death wc iNasy iw e mut Bah ht i) p She=iy Ud Le ey bd Atte 4 aaa Woes ei AY ——_ ater id Bale Tin 9 veny cltedepy iv) dul aed Real ‘ertad hgh Oisie Tak eee ’ i as | be te Wee itl 4 May te ‘Af Pt ¥ it Li rye a Ay phd a : viel o. bye) WPL Al iA), Birt Wiad Meee | ed ion iu pant Gn 4™ ar " RO dabei) oh di VF | bi, Neat Lee el ae teeny se Ab feted TT ea i ae We Gipse 2e) | somes I hye efi hin F tay jj 5 ani eet Bay," We ; aR ULeW fih demebial ot kta itr tng bent Yat alien We noha hen; aL 4) be ee ilkws iusto Byers ibis ee aa aie ile Pia et We cue iid See ae Tiley ye) Ai) Gow wih jee TaLirina rage YA RIE 8 nae i} a) asic al Gable : As +} Ke) mien qt) Tis fal) (ihe ike wl ay im vii Ut iae elie J © vip polis Abadi rebar “ eae od Avil Mee eau} ait ei 4 AOR mn - JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE VIII, Illustrating Mr. Hepworth’s paper on the Mandibles of Acaride. Fig. 1.—A portion of human skin, including an itch pustule ; 48 diameters. a, ova of Acarus Scabiei. b, young insects. c, effete matter deposited by insects. 2.—Full-grown insect, Acarus Scabiei ; 65 diameters. 3.—Mandible of ditto; 890 diameters. 4,— i of Acarus Sacchari (female) ; 390 diameters. 5.— a of = (male); 390 diameters. 6.— = of Acarus of domestic Fly ; 680 diameters. 7.*— ,, of Long-legged Spider ; 80 diameters. 8.— af of Acarus of Blue Beetle and Humble Bee. 9.7— ,, of Cheese Mite ; 390 diameters. 10.— » Of Chelifer cancroides ; 65 diameters. lla ,, of parasite of Mole ; 240 diameters. b, proboscis ; 240 diameters. 12,.— - of another parasite of Mole; 240 diameters. 138.— aS of parasite of Rabbit ; 240 diameters. 14.—Mandibles of parasite of Water Rat ; 200 diameters. * Perhaps, instead of calling these mandibles, they would more properly come under the term maxillary palpi; as in the Scorpion. It appears to be one of the non-spinning Arachnidans, If a leg get accidentally torn off, there is a spasmodic twitching, which continues some seconds in the severed limb. This is so familiar a phenomenon that there will be little difficulty in recognising the kind of spider I mean. As I am an inquirer, I shall be glad to see any remarks on the subject. t+ Rymer Jones says (R. J.’s ‘Animal Kingdom,’ p. 308), in speaking of the Acarida, “The mouth seems adapted for suction, and the jaws form a piercing instrument, barbed at the extremity.’’? Note.—I have not been able to detect. this piercing instrument: it has two powerful mandibles, as seen above, and equally powerful maxilla; and in action they indicate too much motion, and which is of a different character to that where suction is accomplished. How could a flour mite (which has precisely the same kind of apparatus) subsist on dry flour, if it had organs adapted to suction only? I can easily conceive how the parasite of the Mole (fig. 11), with its barbed proboscis, could live by suction. JH.del. Taffen West sculp. Ford & West Imp. MS ATELY BO notre uct E dana g Patt ag ine“ Sed eiflatotbiis or. Ad vive estat & Pei 4 OH Oi AL - | be ) > ‘ - ni, ii ‘es Dei ive. Pee Serv shank. ok bY AH OAL (1 hodwouok at ho alba Ay aniteotA: Fan lbirtcin 7 a saga folhipe Tel oveuana ; i" D5 Oa 9G fh wee ViGOks sdizl sang lig ter gies : Sst thera | Piel 34 eA sites Pyren) “ort Seite tia Tuy idl say Lee Sn ee eet oll hy oto sirad ik Sgt hrestning ) On AY ee eeernze) inftip 3 heh hing) ES oigity uo Ue OO ane sti 1G at i s. sere Slekate: ine oi! nut des toons ident yon § iN Augers Ki pint. a6. geafoalily gui! tlaie a) pieced ul seb leeatfutt ‘ols nd. mrs (h) ditnonhy mo (Oy ant — ed oe det ied till Dn ee Akh ssi)! fo FP en ltiny lina terse Wier yo iiey vate mine og eae Socata prions Poa BOTT TS Haale trey sofia a Cokgergam) Aid 4 daly Yo SO 30h Bie ae ; a Z L nes P . Sue ey ieponiin A S17 pty let he: OW saieniagHl ie = . agit: aye datinitig ytd 0 FO GD va bidder Yale My AC weal SPT oe 7 Po piety Ae bY Ra harolg ok : NOTATY thd te Yo tok Ort) Wee as Bs Bf ' dtl wd YR AS ce F DO suiudlaminn (Ih ion Woe? Re eiteot! ori? 9s ph sth iS ADRS Eh Rye toh =e adit ah oj dina AATHOY by slicotvoy & DUN Oh Aten JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE IX., Ilustrating Dr. Thudichum’s paper on Green Pigment Degeneration of Muscle. Fig. a 1.—Piece of degenerated muscular fibre from wall of left ventricle. Transverse striz interrupted by longitudinal lines. Granular green pigment scattered along the axis of the fibre. 2.—Pieces of fibre with longitudinal lines (the striz# have disappeared) ; a, nucleus, and pigment deposits at both ends of the nucleus; b, patch of pigment corpuscles, found at equal distances along a fibre. 3.—Pieces of fibre, much macerated, from the right ventricle. Transverse strie little indurated. Exhibits the striking difference of true fat (6) from pigment (a). 4.—Nerve fibril from right septum. 5.—The same after boiling with ether and cooling. The cylinder axis (serrated) has disappeared, and fat globules are deposited against the outer membrane of the fibril. Illustrating Mr. Weston’s paper on Actinophrys Sol. Fig. 3.—Actinophrys Sol drawn by Camera lucida; a a, two Vorticella en- closed in a vesicle ; }, vesicle. 4,.—A, Sol in the act of self-division. 5.— a ; ; At = 4 SM TA PTA Bae ds ss liebet * ¢ Se 4 ee ¥ e 7 ial ae 42 : oo - ales (yh AL A ‘'] A » : ae a. i a a i 4 1 PIES y, tf 7 (“i= ‘a y am i,* 7 ballads aL © Si leis ‘ i] il i is y - . i OLE) Bd Wh Sat bee awit bar 4 - sy ZA i : ‘; : ‘ ; 7 » a as j z vist yay a nat aa “Te Y CMP MIESRY eh (eo MIRA GGT HY as sh iY al a PA Dini? Met of i TU ae Ree ie TY Hegel : 7 >. . ee Wa aU a) t ninth afd joi bah ¥/ ult i ‘ Z : : eign A x = 5 = ¥ : : id Uh iagy a = 2, ie A 5 os . : Lely 9a ly 1D Furi veal Thai WIE ay ee 7S HUNG Te sha GE a a orl M4 Jin! . = 7 ; ‘ b! s ‘ Sh a is P _ a eng (eh. S0iS) 4b Tie vies A ae) init ft na : ni PEO Util Gs Lag ¥ aad we isi J (Te as ‘= ‘ oo wren iui ica o hid, ca VARty ; F : a et 61) Oe eee iq! { r Lael a, OT il qy) ah meth. i: i, wei R ah ders rn j ot Walttid i Me a) GVO A Ww vatet Te le doit ha Ww ag t. ‘ : Rare ati i ici A MI belde wits v4 j r Wahid Pall be ia | ie a crite At fil) " Bi i! HG a 3 ; . ee iy ull “ = : oe + Ga ; aL ae = : , ns wore ty hatha ‘¥ | oN a 7 : = 60 1d ioe rt ¥ - : a. Sir bee Toit y ; _- - pt tial Wir fuha) 0 uli jh iis (iin Hct A - ey, q | i 7 - « a s 4 uy -_ Se - 2 - n + 7 7 7 . Os ie = y - 7 \ A I ee JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. EXPLANATION OF PLATE X. Illustrating Mr. Huxley’s paper on A ppendicularia. Fig. 1.—Appendicularia flagellum seen from the side to which the caudal appendage is attached, 7. e. the dorsal or hamal side. 2.—Body of Appendicularia, magnified ; side view. 3.—Body of Appendicularia, magnified ; dorsal view. 4,—Caudal appendage; showing the great nerve, with its ganglionic enlargements. A, Body. 3B, appendage. a, oral aperture. b, pharynx, giving off its lateral canals. c, external opening of these canals. d, ciliated circular bands, corresponding with the stigmata of the branchial sac in ordinary Ascidians ; but here forming part of the wall of the canal }, c. é, anus. J, rectum. g, esophageal narrowing of pharynx. h, right lobe of stomach. z, left lobe. k, testis. 1, axis of caudal appendage. m, rounded granular masses projecting from the hemal wall of the pharynx, and of doubtful nature. n, Endostyle ; here, as elsewhere in the Ascidians, the optical expres- sion of the thickened bottom of a groove or fold, continuous at its edges with the epipharyngeal bands. o, one end of the heart. p, ganglion. q, ciliated sac. 7, Otolithic sac, s, nerve trunk. t, ganglionic enlargements upon its caudal portion. Mier Seurn VW LK { qu wee aaa a a a see = hat THE. ad nat del. Tuffen West sculp Ford # West Imp ‘7 Kei Wee sie, Ful | ee e Cam Bone eS by) Abi head - 1) lee tae etm 7 ieee. ide ‘fhe Wes _ ae yr bl tis ot gtd pi 10 bie, iv tonya aa ' SSD EE DL Tslin ary a eit, oa i i hs mis ‘ip PDA Stl OIA, Mt ln aR ‘foe Pam anti one | lg tl” 50 ast ih fitig’ trisorta: Sei) ey r: Lie) "a pane BS, ce EY f Sy uary ip litiey pees rm ah: Pee Z “Sa submigth ey, Ulntsy en peel tia PH raheastsy yy i ae 1% | 5 t ans aut ode AAAS: Binds ivi ‘o oie he ; ibe ei PLANT eb ine /hthg ve ace i : Hf Si sth 4 ri, he Kite mi) Arh qh Tem te eae ny ae M 3 eagle: Pee i why YA peloaiy Mil i OER . Bian wratgepal i, | Pet ye jee a “a . Bbc) Atel ee Pris deni iahhign ass vi x) ie ost Do 4 Nae ite , ter ae pelvis 892 Nebee Pas fiat eh AA) a 3 ee Me Saeed : ij ' Ms ; : iapivnisraly” belt . ve, ees ay my ii a ft Hin Je male hen Wot rh oi a aires cg 2 ra i yee we , a) fim Dee ety! tthe vi Sue iu ; anT sini SucNoh, jie ARIS ST ‘ 3 Wien. se Rear i ert ree itamedia Fiyartasaity puis ie (a arted ele ROD ALY re Me itil el teanheiss ha wetter el bb bot WTS a eae i ir - a. Re ra PE) WiteMne « Ai! Pie re tne] ite ious eee, He Mes a Tay, Oey iH Meine la Pr) hg Os ae Adee AG, eos ie baal’ we" si a ~ aed ye yt : d ere 1 org aii ; we: ie pee] at) + ‘fhe songs Ae Lae CL SNA “teeiksls doa ate ae Bae Bei alana Up tie rtis bes 30 fa a Bryhn t, 4) pei fer te dima Dh ryt ; Oe toting se PRG Maly ih vino iy EL iit ete AES iT Ra eo ALTA os ae viel on iain oe TAI ee a, i Pe) rf au ii a sah Fars Solin: SWerio’ Sit oe a ee AL) orl oes halas «SCONES APRON ata x rr OE fh bined ry He, a » hi! Aue ie : Bg SO Sma h ah Dir: ni + uit ap ions jodi eres re. Ae baa hae o 110k ne" if wl kyo Bik, Ro oe ae > a Osteigt: Os" hoe ile af oe Pik: fs oe f us he 7 “ine 6m bo roe arth hy seautiteat ese ith, ih to As mut al i ce brie ilods: Jhisonpat Pr-C Le io: ea 400 Sia whe ee pred tsif. Shay a uaa A Doetiaee JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XI. Illustrating Mr. Currey’s paper on the Reproductive Organs of Fungi. Fig. 1.—A stellate spore of Stilbospora militaris, magnified 500 diameters. 2.—An abnormal spore of the same, magnified 350 diameters. Two of the horns have failed to grow. 3.—The apex of a filament and fascicle of spores of Stilbospora militaris, magnified 500 diameters. 4.—The apex of another filament and fascicle, magnified 850 diameters. 5.—A vertical section of a pulvinulus of Stilbospora militaris, magnified 60 diameters. 6.—Conidia of Stilbospora militaris, magnified 500 diameters. 7.—A fascicle of Stilbospora militaris, throwing out a germ-filament. Magnified 350 diameters. 8 and 9.—Asci and sporidia of the Spheria accompanying Steganosporium cellulosum. It is probably Spheria amblyospora, Magnified 220 diameters. The ascus, fig. 9, is in an earlier stage than fig. 8, the sporidia being of a paler colour, and the gelatinous envelope not developed. 10 to 15.—Varieties of sporidia of Steganosporiuwm cellulosum, magnified 220 diameters. 16 and 17.—Empty asci borne upon the stratum proliferum of Stegano- sporium cellulosum. The internal second membrane is very visible. Magnified 220 diameters. 18 and 19.—Bodies also borne upon the stratum proliferum of the Stegano- sportum. 'The endochrome is divided into eight portions, being apparently imperfect sporidia. Magnified 220 diameters. 20 and 21.—Ripe sporidia of Spheerta amblyospora, magnified 220 dia- meters. 22, 23, and 24.—Spores of Steganosporiwm cellulosum at the commence- ment of germination. Attached to one of the germ-filaments is a globular vesicle, possibly adventitious. Magnified 220 dia- meters. 25.—A sporidium of Steganosporiwm cellulosum after about three days’ germination. Magnified 220 diameters. 26.—An ascus and sporidia of Spheria cryptosporii, magnified 220 dia- meters. 27 and 28.—Stylospores or perhaps imperfect asci of the same Spheria, magnified 220 diameters. 29, 30, and 81.—Abnormal asci of Spheria cryptosporii. The contents are granular, but there is no symptom of the formation of sporidia. Magnified 220 diameters. 32 and 33.—Curious instances of dehiscence of the asci of Spheria her- barum. In fig. 32 the second membrane is clearly visible at both ends of the broken ascus. In fig. 83 the second membrane is reduced to a string, and encloses a single sporidium. Magnified 220 diameters, MNuer Srurn Vb VGA if Be ns Ny & F Currey del Tutfen West sculp Ford & West Imp a MH TOROA (sae is ware t : te JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XII. Figures of Camphor-crystal, illustrative of the observations of Messrs. Spencer and Glaisher. roe yf matty ot a ete Oe . - i } a Re : = . 7 " : on : phe ery Bs * VE Atay. . a0 Ss Ke Pang eis ‘pstregy ae Bos Liked itt intend re Mpanaieat raf AR, nae re aries é - - 5 , . > - Ram i= G 7 : 4 < Les pe ab. a 26 te oe Sat Aaah! BA via fis fy) RC = 2 Ly 5 wit a Soke meh owe aE At 3 at i me ore a0 pgs : fe ca ya b Mt 6 Lye ay ae Biv Dewi tote tiie SABE 4, Pairisiéebgn ai iy elm - ny . ee bOI | car etanbert fF vaideyicy eer LL (ae, Lee eo ae ;, on AS . 3295 the Rate baer Fdsmhin LER ahi win Aa om a et Seer! she ace fan {Habeas ae Failte 2 a 4 é BMC BY Ob RAO: ~, iy sid SN) iW 1s AN . ’ A ee T= oadorpiath uta or : ; ie : o th : ‘ tude pt eit RC eae Bay sass we a ig att ayett si ae oy my JD He Tipo 1 bord MeN) +e Whe vA hil ti, willelsh ole sateen ies We sik Ogos | imparts pe = - ; ; Fay at ( igo WAS ae i ey sl). tplet y weet pes Pe oe a*; i mi able Vigh) Pamaysy ‘A 5 Erp uf ik (Wee eg #,. Afi rhe she yale mabe, 6) ih ea oe Bar ‘one Saryaaeeaiy" 4 is ny ele a aR Be ah; jie ypint POP PAL id ght Soh ae ets stag lao) owen db WOE 1 yh aps Egon te Liber HOME AL y VSM bye dM Re Ma iy! ee Ove e si) Dalian ae Bayh rye Gabe: eye Lesa eat. Spit hele epi oye a of SAV enon atl aE VANE Oe Se Geka) hy Bll) i tien vale 5 a raving outs Tt OMS gelaierny is) ‘ott bow Bing ale ia nee |. ps gal? Atta er rigu (O° MaY BAER poalg aaah ath , ae ie Y i ae ees A; ane nin? ott Wrap 2 JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XIII, Illustrating Dr. John Charles Hall’s paper on an Easy Method of viewing certain of the Diatomacee. Fig. 1.—Pleurosiyma angulatum ; colour pale chesnut: strie 52 in *001"; length *0066" to 0100"; this figure is intended to give a general view of the appearance it presents when viewed with this peculiar illumination, and magnified about 800 diameters. 2.*—The same magnified about 2,000 diameters. 3.—Pleurosigma Hippocampus; colour pale brown : long striae 32 in 001"; transverse striz 40 in *001"; length ‘0050 to :0066"; magnified 800 diameters. 4,—The same magnified 1,200 diameters, showing both the transverse and longitudinal strize : a portion is also seen in dots. 5.—Pleurosigma Formosum; colour light chesnut-brown; strize 36 in "001"; length °0141 to :0178", * Since the present paper was in type, I have seen the very interesting book of Dr, Carpenter “ On the Microscope :” in it, at page 307, will be found an engraving, from a photograph of Mr. Wenham, of the Plewrosigma angulatum, as seen under a power of 15,000 diameters. On comparing this with fig. 2, in the present plate, the correctness of Mr, Fleming’s delineation will at once be apparent. Dr, Carpenter, after having examined the valve with an objective having an angular aperture of 130°, and very oblique rays, states that its hexagonal arecolation becomes very distinct ;” he states also, ‘‘ that when the object is accurately in focus, the hexagonal arez are seen to be light, and the intervening spaces dark,” the reverse being the case when out of focus ; this, of course, does not in any way affect the question, as to the nature of these markings. I consider fig. 2, in the present plate, to be in focus.—J. C, H. ADs oFe =. ee eens TTS RPT ei I ddd e * Pe Somme Lecetesinyaqei iii tritt DOs aoc? o° pace dog Tap Daa i} Li 28e0 Pag e Ran ee PPP Fo 5, Lng pe 88500 Sorcoa ee gacaaer” eoeeere? bili nema nnenent 718 ney i” a ict 7 Prtix: ABC" 0 0 er BOK; le i. 0 hae) iS ar. Ee . ry fe : Soe eS ie. ; ee | a - ’ ae i . ae ‘ + * a h od et?) : Ber Aes 30-MG PIED 0 4: ae ; or - oe - “ae a 1 La ari Hout} Hil ate asd Enos is Le . ee a te 7 © SAS Bie! ts 7 cect i nd th 1 is: ee i o. he tei rite a . > ai TRIBUTES: eit a) ki fe hepa fi ny oF elas 49 ocee eee - itt yee a oT eae eS Pea ALS Morea HAY Bev A 19 ei Wate 2 se 7 ay . *, Je fa PAL IE pve a jt eae) aes ERY a Fas i 7% eek iri vrs a t ‘Wiet 7 7 or o =e . a ia co + Es for al denise Ths of ee os 1 Se . by a i ‘ ; +m e af ute hes a ey . ser - tA P= reer Pf 2 rs 4 me) Hats, ay’ hee Sec 4) ies em ; (>a 29 ve eth as, ‘ = iat aie bi . Hein, ere a ua ee hy he ‘ a, * ; 7 Ce * ie ‘ OT RO, apaly- ai nition , a g Se, ty Qi gi Haggai Arage like rel! iy, $e tcne — « = > Pail ati is Oty) m : ; ws 7 * OW ae thats | 2 a A Ok i . =* ‘ = " = . : Path me ier ‘oe ~ x48 ; % im, * > md ' 4 sey ag “y re eT ee | need iP bape & sm ina aa : oat itn Ly 4 * ae field} cant), Sad. aT Ml). SoM Le EOL ae 4a} rath ge ih 7 oY Shik hice Ms dacfelb sapien irin OF), i. TILT Hints ee Ai | lin “Sa F301 van . PS ete Page bad’ n , aes Sanh ; Pa Suid ar ra a7) ih ate Rei St art ) to addieo Tes wits! Bee phic AP ee J ee dndesnsiln hltaay, 2 6.2 VFA TOM Ue LL SA eae rita Mill 0 Me pe ah =< _ tered! ja” fet Tynes as Del baey any len itive #cigtualtile yee et re Ba “ati PAF Oh ut (ANP te (a YOUR. PO eee a. i a 3 Pe ht io Ss « ; i ‘ ie oe ue one y WE dow lte Se le etre et he sity Si : a as ys pi asigin pall i} i sh herliya: aN: sae if ae) pA TS PAG rhinalhe :.. ls aig ber vy i C) Figoy wey eee a a i ri hd fii ache Ap ra a7 OVE od Renatatand etl, far: itt » oh PSs ‘fe AG | eS = “4s 7 f er fie Hens ily sO hi im Hite a mi y 4 4 Hibs tbl g bie sth h oa rig ear / ha Ma - ’ . « " ‘ 7 y i _ npit,' 1 ~\ «= * 7 ¥ we ‘ * @ 7 = 4 ‘ * in tae @ a ek. i ek ee a, aa > *) ; 4 7 ’ ta ' > f a * - * : py ? : in oS vex. aT , et ae 0 ti. Ne * : e . . = 7 4 JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XIV., Illustrating Dr. D’Alquen’s paper on the Structure of Oscillatoria. Fig. 1.—Portion of a filament of Oscillatoria contexta, showing the striated proper cell-membrane. 2.—A detached empty piece of this cell-membrane. 3.—Portion of filament treated with iodine. a. Entire portion. b. Proper cell-membrane slightly affected by the reagent. c. The plain unstriated cellulose sheath or tube. d, Single joint on end. 4.—Portion of filament treated by weak syrup. 5.—Ditto by a strong solution of chloride of calcium. 6,—Ditto by a weak ditto. 7.—Ideal section of a filament, showing the concentric arrangement of its different tissues. a. Vertical section. b. Horizontal section. ce. Solid axis. d. Layer of protoplasm coloured by chlorophyll. e. Proper cell-membrane. 8.—Portion of filament, displaying the manner in which the cell-contents are sometimes observed to separate while under the action of iodine. 9.—a. Portion of filament. b. The same as seen on end, having the appearance of a lenticular disk. 10.—Portion of filament after desiccation and treatment by iodine, show- ing the shrunken axis of the filament in the form of a green thread. 11.—Ditto not dried, showing this thread between the separated portions of the filament. 12, 138.—Filaments with modified cells representing gonidia. 14.—A new species of Oscillatoria, having its cells not coloured by chlorophyll. 15.—The same, with some of its cells filled out. Illustrating Dr. Lankester’s paper on Fungi in drinking water. 16.—Mycelium of Fungus. a, enlargements seen on larger branches. 17.—Particles passing through the branches of the Mycelium. 18.—Spore case of the same Fungus. 19.—Mycelium of a Fungus. 6, moving particles. | F.D'Algquen del * =F E I o ‘ ° é 7 “ » ~ » a * a . z ” eee | a 3 o = - ~y : Ps — 4 - S “ ¢ i. 2 4 y he = J - 4 a i : > ' “oe am ie Pe Sigind ey = =f + 7 > a ‘ ‘ x o PAG +; \ ie aS 4 a -" an » .) ) “ Gs eA fy y | A 6) bv AMI HU Ties yi V VAM t \ oe Ny : Pe a vs Syy CDe Morgan del. Tuffen West sculp WWest Lah? at - _ t plone rs Pc A oe olin, 7 i — es : Ss so _ = ‘ ia a a ~ ? :e i ’ 1 7 Pa ins uf re ner ics Bea cs! oe ‘Teeter de: me eh Be os i bi, : ab Feith if me en rude ia me MR a 7 2 ae Ue gh PA AGRI AD aa REE NEE fs ca : i eh LH tae i LPy aaa a bad a pe -— : spinal <¥ es if Be te ee dt esas ats: tyr) ‘vp ee tance a Br fs: Miva: z aed att Fe Qa e ies! gg can Vas PO a en 2 ney ® a: if a arena sh aie uy ay sh vie Me Nis “ Pa’ pee) risrte rt Bet ie vat ie Be ay Ps Rat ley F Wei M7 pe At ligt ae ‘$id Me Winks case =k ; , _ rik. e we oh peri tries cat) G\r taint ers Dat ae a, hurd Cicer soy, if gi thee ] : Lom rales ee sy 1) ea py, Vie ny seh ee Lic tee mY [wi = here: Pr. et ar: Pei eh coe Gack), ar ek ont is PW}. tc nd MH ED ] Ait ey oe ; th ‘ -wtieriyant Palla Uh Tay =e PO Sgt reir", i: er ra Thane pte i- yh ante yi ve and ae pede e tg ofip = ne = ee : Asta ats - he sha tigi int “14 ate iN Jee ty =A alah , ; i ye a , > | - Uy 7 a | rc a ae Ae ; 4 Dike Ws a roa Tae NATL igtd. Le VIS Fel (TTA ieee. oul i ie st eee ~~ Saeibeuenis.) |" 4 Ke F Be 5s aa “A ‘ oP a z , i ; cd ty ak mae bs) aie , ‘4s : ald d i ee 3S F 7 A one i ag ‘ ] = Ml 7 ie ry $y eee > 4 . " : ' : 1 A iy ina at 2: a { ie Sar Tenby | Ptr st. ¥ re ond pe pe re 434 2 ei pity ‘ : , : rah P Ag eS, hs | eee AS ae Toa ahaa bile Bi xe A 7 - Pond ‘ ia ER , P ig a wiay wl Beh! : Ris i Mie fa a Isai ibid ! c : : oa wt id j my. ‘io. i 8 me Ma A P mer Y 4% | a ah ie Cat 90 “ease rif w Dc Ny ah aes Mag eur AY ab Ay - ¥ ne £ - ire 7 < * 7 “aE Nig mae or ‘ Fie er at Jue ; Si, 4 % ; e er f. «A 18, . — ’ . - > ip, ; : s 7 ee . = . ee os 7 eas ae ¥ » a yr oa aor ae bs » if . j _* : fi ‘ * : aha’ y { oe : ; ts a sie ‘ ¥ ad y «< fi L] * ; , : *s i f Py } ey || E fi an ad | oi j *- 4p » rs a deliv ra : 4 aa als . ’ 2" in \ JOURNAL OF MICROSCOPICAL SCIENCE. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XVII. Illustrating Mr. Brightwell’s second communication on the Genus Triceratium. Fig. 1.—T. exiguum, W. Sm. _ 4, front view. 2.—T. parmula (un. sp.) 3.—T. brachiatum (n. sp.) 4.—T. truneatum (n. sp.) 5.—T. venosum (n. sp.) 6.—T. coniferum (n. sp.). 6, partial front view. 7.—T. Farus B. 8.—T. formosum +. 9.—T. armatum, Roper. 9 b, front view. Dr. Bailey’s figure of 7. setigerum (Smith’s Contr. 1854) very strongly resembles ours. 10.—T. armatum, a. 11.— a B. 115, front view of a four-sided specimen. 12.— BS 7. 13.—T. marginatum (n. sp.) 14.—T. radiatum (n. sp.) 15.—T. Tabellarium (n. sp.) 16.—T. hyalinum (n. sp.) 17.—T. Marylandicum (n. sp.) 18.—T. punctatum (n. sp.) 19.—T. variable (n. sp.) Three of the very numerous and bizarre forms of this curious species are represented. 20.—T. orbiculatum, Shadbolt. 6, front view. * The figures are all magnified 400 diameters, with the exception of figs. 5, 6, 7, 8, 9,10, 12, 13, 14, 20, which are only X 300. cee he sec, OKI’ Goran A SAN e > oie} oO 8 %ana, 29 ey .2 ae a =| » ie re ZOOPHYTOLOGY. ~~ late, IX. G.Busk, del. : Ford &West,Inm. ZOOPHY TOLOGY Ford & West, [mp ‘Busk, del fal As, ZOCPHRY TOLOGY. Plate, Xl GBusk. del Ford West, imp. LOOPHY TOLOGY. Plate,Xll [EA ear Oe 5 SE a ea | G.Pusk, del. Ford & West, imp .